-Wstringop-truncation warnings
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf.c
1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /*
24 SECTION
25 ELF backends
26
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
30
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
34
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
36 #define _SYSCALL32
37 #include "sysdep.h"
38 #include "bfd.h"
39 #include "bfdlink.h"
40 #include "libbfd.h"
41 #define ARCH_SIZE 0
42 #include "elf-bfd.h"
43 #include "libiberty.h"
44 #include "safe-ctype.h"
45 #include "elf-linux-core.h"
46
47 #ifdef CORE_HEADER
48 #include CORE_HEADER
49 #endif
50
51 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
52 static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
53 static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
54 static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
55 static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type,
56 size_t align) ;
57 static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
58 file_ptr offset, size_t align);
59
60 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
61 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
62 need to move into elfcode.h. */
63
64 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
65
66 void
67 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
68 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
69 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
70 {
71 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
72 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
73 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
74 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
75 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
76 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
77 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
78 }
79
80 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
81
82 void
83 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
84 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
85 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
86 {
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
89 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
90 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
92 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
93 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
94 }
95
96 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
97
98 void
99 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
100 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
101 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
102 {
103 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
104 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
105 }
106
107 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
108
109 void
110 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
111 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
112 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
113 {
114 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
115 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
116 }
117
118 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
119
120 void
121 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
122 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
123 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
124 {
125 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
126 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
127 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
128 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
129 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
130 }
131
132 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
133
134 void
135 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
136 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
137 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
138 {
139 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
140 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
142 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
143 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
144 }
145
146 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
147
148 void
149 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
150 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
151 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
152 {
153 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
154 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
155 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
156 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
157 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
158 }
159
160 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
161
162 void
163 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
164 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
165 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
166 {
167 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
168 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
169 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
170 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
171 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
172 }
173
174 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
175
176 void
177 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
178 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
179 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
180 {
181 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
182 }
183
184 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
185
186 void
187 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
188 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
189 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
190 {
191 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
192 }
193
194 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
195 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
196
197 unsigned long
198 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
199 {
200 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
201 unsigned long h = 0;
202 unsigned long g;
203 int ch;
204
205 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
206 {
207 h = (h << 4) + ch;
208 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
209 {
210 h ^= g >> 24;
211 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
212 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
213 h ^= g;
214 }
215 }
216 return h & 0xffffffff;
217 }
218
219 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
220 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
221
222 unsigned long
223 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
224 {
225 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
226 unsigned long h = 5381;
227 unsigned char ch;
228
229 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
230 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
231 return h & 0xffffffff;
232 }
233
234 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
235 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
236 bfd_boolean
237 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
238 size_t object_size,
239 enum elf_target_id object_id)
240 {
241 BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
242 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
243 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
244 return FALSE;
245
246 elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
247 if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
248 {
249 struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
250 if (o == NULL)
251 return FALSE;
252 elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
253 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
254 }
255 return TRUE;
256 }
257
258
259 bfd_boolean
260 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
261 {
262 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
263 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
264 bed->target_id);
265 }
266
267 bfd_boolean
268 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
269 {
270 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
271 if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
272 return FALSE;
273 elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
274 return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
275 }
276
277 static char *
278 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
279 {
280 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
281 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
282 file_ptr offset;
283 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
284
285 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
286 if (i_shdrp == 0
287 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
288 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
289 return NULL;
290
291 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
292 if (shstrtab == NULL)
293 {
294 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
295 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
296 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
297
298 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
299 in case the string table is not terminated. */
300 if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
301 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
302 || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL)
303 shstrtab = NULL;
304 else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
305 {
306 if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
307 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
308 bfd_release (abfd, shstrtab);
309 shstrtab = NULL;
310 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
311 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
312 the string table over and over. */
313 i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
314 }
315 else
316 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
317 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
318 }
319 return (char *) shstrtab;
320 }
321
322 char *
323 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
324 unsigned int shindex,
325 unsigned int strindex)
326 {
327 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
328
329 if (strindex == 0)
330 return "";
331
332 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
333 return NULL;
334
335 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
336
337 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
338 {
339 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
340 {
341 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
342 /* xgettext:c-format */
343 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: attempt to load strings from"
344 " a non-string section (number %d)"),
345 abfd, shindex);
346 return NULL;
347 }
348
349 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
350 return NULL;
351 }
352
353 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
354 {
355 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
356 _bfd_error_handler
357 /* xgettext:c-format */
358 (_("%pB: invalid string offset %u >= %" PRIu64 " for section `%s'"),
359 abfd, strindex, (uint64_t) hdr->sh_size,
360 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
361 ? ".shstrtab"
362 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
363 return NULL;
364 }
365
366 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
367 }
368
369 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
370 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
371 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
372 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
373 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
374 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
375 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
376
377 Elf_Internal_Sym *
378 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
379 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
380 size_t symcount,
381 size_t symoffset,
382 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
383 void *extsym_buf,
384 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
385 {
386 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
387 void *alloc_ext;
388 const bfd_byte *esym;
389 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
390 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
391 Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
392 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
393 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
394 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
395 size_t extsym_size;
396 bfd_size_type amt;
397 file_ptr pos;
398
399 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
400 abort ();
401
402 if (symcount == 0)
403 return intsym_buf;
404
405 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
406 shndx_hdr = NULL;
407 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
408 {
409 elf_section_list * entry;
410 Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
411
412 /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
413 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
414 {
415 /* PR 20063. */
416 if (entry->hdr.sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
417 continue;
418
419 if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
420 {
421 shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
422 break;
423 };
424 }
425
426 if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
427 {
428 if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
429 /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
430 shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
431 /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
432 the index table will not be needed. */
433 }
434 }
435
436 /* Read the symbols. */
437 alloc_ext = NULL;
438 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
439 alloc_intsym = NULL;
440 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
441 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
442 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * extsym_size;
443 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
444 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
445 {
446 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
447 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
448 }
449 if (extsym_buf == NULL
450 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
451 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
452 {
453 intsym_buf = NULL;
454 goto out;
455 }
456
457 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
458 extshndx_buf = NULL;
459 else
460 {
461 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
462 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
463 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
464 {
465 alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
466 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
467 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
468 }
469 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
470 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
471 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
472 {
473 intsym_buf = NULL;
474 goto out;
475 }
476 }
477
478 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
479 {
480 alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
481 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
482 intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
483 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
484 goto out;
485 }
486
487 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
488 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
489 for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
490 shndx = extshndx_buf;
491 isym < isymend;
492 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
493 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
494 {
495 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
496 /* xgettext:c-format */
497 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB symbol number %lu references"
498 " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
499 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
500 if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
501 free (alloc_intsym);
502 intsym_buf = NULL;
503 goto out;
504 }
505
506 out:
507 if (alloc_ext != NULL)
508 free (alloc_ext);
509 if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
510 free (alloc_extshndx);
511
512 return intsym_buf;
513 }
514
515 /* Look up a symbol name. */
516 const char *
517 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
518 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
519 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
520 asection *sym_sec)
521 {
522 const char *name;
523 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
524 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
525
526 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
527 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
528 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
529 {
530 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
531 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
532 }
533
534 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
535 if (name == NULL)
536 name = "(null)";
537 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
538 name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
539
540 return name;
541 }
542
543 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
544 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
545 pointers. */
546
547 typedef union elf_internal_group {
548 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
549 unsigned int flags;
550 } Elf_Internal_Group;
551
552 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
553 signature just a string? */
554
555 static const char *
556 group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
557 {
558 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
559 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
560 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
561 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
562
563 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
564 that it is a symbol table section. */
565 if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
566 return NULL;
567 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
568 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
569 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
570 return NULL;
571
572 /* Go read the symbol. */
573 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
574 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
575 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
576 return NULL;
577
578 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
579 }
580
581 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
582
583 static bfd_boolean
584 setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
585 {
586 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
587
588 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
589 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
590 if (num_group == 0)
591 {
592 unsigned int i, shnum;
593
594 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
595 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
596 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
597 num_group = 0;
598
599 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
600 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
601 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
602 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
603 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
604
605 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
606 {
607 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
608
609 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
610 num_group += 1;
611 }
612
613 if (num_group == 0)
614 {
615 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
616 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
617 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
618 }
619 else
620 {
621 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
622 so we can find them quickly. */
623 bfd_size_type amt;
624
625 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
626 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
627 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
628 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
629 return FALSE;
630 memset (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr, 0, num_group * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
631 num_group = 0;
632
633 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
634 {
635 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
636
637 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
638 {
639 unsigned char *src;
640 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
641
642 /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
643 attached to it. */
644 if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
645 return FALSE;
646
647 /* Add to list of sections. */
648 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
649 num_group += 1;
650
651 /* Read the raw contents. */
652 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
653 amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
654 shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
655 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
656 /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
657 if (shdr->contents == NULL)
658 {
659 _bfd_error_handler
660 /* xgettext:c-format */
661 (_("%pB: corrupt size field in group section"
662 " header: %#" PRIx64),
663 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
664 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
665 -- num_group;
666 continue;
667 }
668
669 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
670
671 if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
672 || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
673 != shdr->sh_size))
674 {
675 _bfd_error_handler
676 /* xgettext:c-format */
677 (_("%pB: invalid size field in group section"
678 " header: %#" PRIx64 ""),
679 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
680 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
681 -- num_group;
682 /* PR 17510: If the group contents are even
683 partially corrupt, do not allow any of the
684 contents to be used. */
685 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
686 continue;
687 }
688
689 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
690 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
691 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
692 pointers. */
693 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
694 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
695
696 while (1)
697 {
698 unsigned int idx;
699
700 src -= 4;
701 --dest;
702 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
703 if (src == shdr->contents)
704 {
705 dest->flags = idx;
706 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
707 shdr->bfd_section->flags
708 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
709 break;
710 }
711 if (idx >= shnum)
712 {
713 _bfd_error_handler
714 (_("%pB: invalid SHT_GROUP entry"), abfd);
715 idx = 0;
716 }
717 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
718 }
719 }
720 }
721
722 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
723 if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
724 {
725 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
726
727 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
728 if (num_group == 0)
729 {
730 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
731 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
732 _bfd_error_handler
733 (_("%pB: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
734 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
735 }
736 }
737 }
738 }
739
740 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
741 {
742 unsigned int search_offset = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset;
743 unsigned int j;
744
745 for (j = 0; j < num_group; j++)
746 {
747 /* Begin search from previous found group. */
748 unsigned i = (j + search_offset) % num_group;
749
750 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
751 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
752 bfd_size_type n_elt;
753
754 if (shdr == NULL)
755 continue;
756
757 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
758 if (idx == NULL || shdr->sh_size < 4)
759 {
760 /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer. */
761 /* xgettext:c-format */
762 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: group section '%pA' has no contents"),
763 abfd, shdr->bfd_section);
764 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i] = NULL;
765 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
766 return FALSE;
767 }
768 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
769
770 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
771 section is a member. */
772 while (--n_elt != 0)
773 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
774 {
775 asection *s = NULL;
776
777 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
778 other members to see if any others are linked via
779 next_in_group. */
780 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
781 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
782 while (--n_elt != 0)
783 if ((s = (++idx)->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
784 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
785 break;
786 if (n_elt != 0)
787 {
788 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
789 insert current section in circular list. */
790 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
791 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
792 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
793 }
794 else
795 {
796 const char *gname;
797
798 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
799 if (gname == NULL)
800 return FALSE;
801 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
802
803 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
804 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
805 }
806
807 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
808 new member. */
809 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
810 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
811
812 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset = i;
813 j = num_group - 1;
814 break;
815 }
816 }
817 }
818
819 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
820 {
821 /* xgettext:c-format */
822 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: no group info for section '%pA'"),
823 abfd, newsect);
824 return FALSE;
825 }
826 return TRUE;
827 }
828
829 bfd_boolean
830 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
831 {
832 unsigned int i;
833 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
834 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
835 asection *s;
836
837 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
838 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
839 {
840 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
841 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
842 {
843 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
844 /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
845 not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
846 get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
847 if (elfsec == 0)
848 {
849 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
850 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
851 bed->link_order_error_handler
852 /* xgettext:c-format */
853 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
854 abfd, s);
855 }
856 else
857 {
858 asection *linksec = NULL;
859
860 if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
861 {
862 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
863 linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
864 }
865
866 /* PR 1991, 2008:
867 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
868 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
869 if (linksec == NULL)
870 {
871 _bfd_error_handler
872 /* xgettext:c-format */
873 (_("%pB: sh_link [%d] in section `%pA' is incorrect"),
874 s->owner, elfsec, s);
875 result = FALSE;
876 }
877
878 elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
879 }
880 }
881 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP
882 && elf_next_in_group (s) == NULL)
883 {
884 _bfd_error_handler
885 /* xgettext:c-format */
886 (_("%pB: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
887 abfd, elf_section_data (s)->this_idx);
888 result = FALSE;
889 }
890 }
891
892 /* Process section groups. */
893 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
894 return result;
895
896 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
897 {
898 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
899 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
900 unsigned int n_elt;
901
902 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
903 if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
904 {
905 _bfd_error_handler
906 /* xgettext:c-format */
907 (_("%pB: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
908 abfd, i);
909 result = FALSE;
910 continue;
911 }
912
913 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
914 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
915
916 while (--n_elt != 0)
917 {
918 ++ idx;
919
920 if (idx->shdr == NULL)
921 continue;
922 else if (idx->shdr->bfd_section)
923 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
924 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA
925 && idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
926 {
927 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
928 _bfd_error_handler
929 /* xgettext:c-format */
930 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%pA]"),
931 abfd,
932 idx->shdr->sh_type,
933 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
934 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
935 ->e_shstrndx),
936 idx->shdr->sh_name),
937 shdr->bfd_section);
938 result = FALSE;
939 }
940 }
941 }
942
943 return result;
944 }
945
946 bfd_boolean
947 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
948 {
949 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
950 }
951
952 static char *
953 convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
954 {
955 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
956 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
957 if (new_name == NULL)
958 return NULL;
959 new_name[0] = '.';
960 new_name[1] = 'z';
961 memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
962 return new_name;
963 }
964
965 static char *
966 convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
967 {
968 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
969 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
970 if (new_name == NULL)
971 return NULL;
972 new_name[0] = '.';
973 memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
974 return new_name;
975 }
976
977 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
978 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
979
980 bfd_boolean
981 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
982 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
983 const char *name,
984 int shindex)
985 {
986 asection *newsect;
987 flagword flags;
988 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
989
990 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
991 return TRUE;
992
993 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
994 if (newsect == NULL)
995 return FALSE;
996
997 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
998 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
999 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
1000
1001 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
1002 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
1003 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
1004
1005 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
1006
1007 if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
1008 || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
1009 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
1010 bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
1011 return FALSE;
1012
1013 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
1014 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1015 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
1016 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
1017 flags |= SEC_GROUP;
1018 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1019 {
1020 flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
1021 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1022 flags |= SEC_LOAD;
1023 }
1024 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
1025 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
1026 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
1027 flags |= SEC_CODE;
1028 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1029 flags |= SEC_DATA;
1030 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
1031 {
1032 flags |= SEC_MERGE;
1033 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
1034 }
1035 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
1036 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
1037 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
1038 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
1039 return FALSE;
1040 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
1041 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
1042 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
1043 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1044
1045 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1046 {
1047 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1048 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1049 if (name [0] == '.')
1050 {
1051 const char *p;
1052 int n;
1053 if (name[1] == 'd')
1054 p = ".debug", n = 6;
1055 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'n')
1056 p = ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", n = 17;
1057 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'd')
1058 p = ".gdb_index", n = 11; /* yes we really do mean 11. */
1059 else if (name[1] == 'l')
1060 p = ".line", n = 5;
1061 else if (name[1] == 's')
1062 p = ".stab", n = 5;
1063 else if (name[1] == 'z')
1064 p = ".zdebug", n = 7;
1065 else
1066 p = NULL, n = 0;
1067 if (p != NULL && strncmp (name, p, n) == 0)
1068 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
1069 }
1070 }
1071
1072 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1073 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1074 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1075 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1076 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1077 all but one of the sections. */
1078 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
1079 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
1080 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1081
1082 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1083 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1084 if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
1085 return FALSE;
1086
1087 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
1088 return FALSE;
1089
1090 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1091 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1092 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1093 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1094 {
1095 bfd_byte *contents;
1096
1097 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1098 return FALSE;
1099
1100 elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size,
1101 hdr->sh_offset, hdr->sh_addralign);
1102 free (contents);
1103 }
1104
1105 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1106 {
1107 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1108 unsigned int i, nload;
1109
1110 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1111 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1112 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1113 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1114 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1115 for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1116 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1117 break;
1118 else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1119 ++nload;
1120 if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1121 return TRUE;
1122
1123 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1124 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1125 {
1126 if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1127 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1128 || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1129 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1130 {
1131 if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1132 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1133 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
1134 else
1135 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1136 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1137 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1138 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1139 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1140 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1141 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1142 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1143 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
1144
1145 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1146 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1147 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1148 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1149 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1150 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1151 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1152 break;
1153 }
1154 }
1155 }
1156
1157 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1158 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1159 if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1160 && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1161 || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1162 {
1163 enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1164 int compression_header_size;
1165 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1166 bfd_boolean compressed
1167 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1168 &compression_header_size,
1169 &uncompressed_size);
1170
1171 if (compressed)
1172 {
1173 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1174 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1175 action = decompress;
1176 }
1177
1178 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1179 section. Check if we should compress. */
1180 if (action == nothing)
1181 {
1182 if (newsect->size != 0
1183 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1184 && compression_header_size >= 0
1185 && uncompressed_size > 0
1186 && (!compressed
1187 || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1188 != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1189 action = compress;
1190 else
1191 return TRUE;
1192 }
1193
1194 if (action == compress)
1195 {
1196 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1197 {
1198 _bfd_error_handler
1199 /* xgettext:c-format */
1200 (_("%pB: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1201 abfd, name);
1202 return FALSE;
1203 }
1204 }
1205 else
1206 {
1207 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1208 {
1209 _bfd_error_handler
1210 /* xgettext:c-format */
1211 (_("%pB: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1212 abfd, name);
1213 return FALSE;
1214 }
1215 }
1216
1217 if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1218 {
1219 if (name[1] == 'z'
1220 && (action == decompress
1221 || (action == compress
1222 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1223 {
1224 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1225 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1226 section. */
1227 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1228 if (new_name == NULL)
1229 return FALSE;
1230 bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
1231 }
1232 }
1233 else
1234 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1235 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1236 newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1237 }
1238
1239 return TRUE;
1240 }
1241
1242 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] =
1243 {
1244 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1245 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1246 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1247 };
1248
1249 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1250 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1251 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1252 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1253 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1254 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1255 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1256 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1257 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1258
1259 bfd_reloc_status_type
1260 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1261 arelent *reloc_entry,
1262 asymbol *symbol,
1263 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1264 asection *input_section,
1265 bfd *output_bfd,
1266 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1267 {
1268 if (output_bfd != NULL
1269 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1270 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1271 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1272 {
1273 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1274 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1275 }
1276
1277 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1278 }
1279 \f
1280 /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1281 Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1282 should be the same. */
1283
1284 static bfd_boolean
1285 section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr * a,
1286 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * b)
1287 {
1288 return
1289 a->sh_type == b->sh_type
1290 && (a->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1291 == (b->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1292 && a->sh_addralign == b->sh_addralign
1293 && a->sh_size == b->sh_size
1294 && a->sh_entsize == b->sh_entsize
1295 /* FIXME: Check sh_addr ? */
1296 ;
1297 }
1298
1299 /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1300 as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1301 none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1302 to be the correct section. */
1303
1304 static unsigned int
1305 find_link (const bfd *obfd, const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1306 const unsigned int hint)
1307 {
1308 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1309 unsigned int i;
1310
1311 BFD_ASSERT (iheader != NULL);
1312
1313 /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1314 if (hint < elf_numsections (obfd)
1315 && oheaders[hint] != NULL
1316 && section_match (oheaders[hint], iheader))
1317 return hint;
1318
1319 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1320 {
1321 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1322
1323 if (oheader == NULL)
1324 continue;
1325 if (section_match (oheader, iheader))
1326 /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1327 multiple matches ? */
1328 return i;
1329 }
1330
1331 return SHN_UNDEF;
1332 }
1333
1334 /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1335 Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1336 Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1337
1338 static bfd_boolean
1339 copy_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd,
1340 bfd *obfd,
1341 const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1342 Elf_Internal_Shdr *oheader,
1343 const unsigned int secnum)
1344 {
1345 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1346 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1347 bfd_boolean changed = FALSE;
1348 unsigned int sh_link;
1349
1350 if (oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
1351 {
1352 /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1353 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1354 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1355 matched up with the original.
1356
1357 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1358 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1359 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1360 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1361 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1362 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1363 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1364 the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1365 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1366 that just contains debug info and only for sections
1367 without any contents. */
1368 if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1369 oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1370 if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1371 oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1372 return TRUE;
1373 }
1374
1375 /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1376 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL
1377 && bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
1378 (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader))
1379 return TRUE;
1380
1381 /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1382 sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1383 the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1384 in the input bfd. */
1385 if (iheader->sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1386 {
1387 /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1388 if (iheader->sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
1389 {
1390 _bfd_error_handler
1391 /* xgettext:c-format */
1392 (_("%pB: invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1393 ibfd, iheader->sh_link, secnum);
1394 return FALSE;
1395 }
1396
1397 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_link], iheader->sh_link);
1398 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1399 {
1400 oheader->sh_link = sh_link;
1401 changed = TRUE;
1402 }
1403 else
1404 /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1405 if we could not find a match ? */
1406 _bfd_error_handler
1407 /* xgettext:c-format */
1408 (_("%pB: failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1409 }
1410
1411 if (iheader->sh_info)
1412 {
1413 /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1414 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1415 section index. */
1416 if (iheader->sh_flags & SHF_INFO_LINK)
1417 {
1418 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_info],
1419 iheader->sh_info);
1420 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1421 oheader->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
1422 }
1423 else
1424 /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1425 sh_link = iheader->sh_info;
1426
1427 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1428 {
1429 oheader->sh_info = sh_link;
1430 changed = TRUE;
1431 }
1432 else
1433 _bfd_error_handler
1434 /* xgettext:c-format */
1435 (_("%pB: failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1436 }
1437
1438 return changed;
1439 }
1440
1441 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1442 another. */
1443
1444 bfd_boolean
1445 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1446 {
1447 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1448 Elf_Internal_Shdr **oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1449 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1450 unsigned int i;
1451
1452 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1453 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1454 return TRUE;
1455
1456 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1457 {
1458 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1459 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1460 }
1461
1462 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1463
1464 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1465 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1466 elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1467
1468 /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1469 if (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION])
1470 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION]
1471 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION];
1472
1473 /* Copy object attributes. */
1474 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1475
1476 if (iheaders == NULL || oheaders == NULL)
1477 return TRUE;
1478
1479 bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1480
1481 /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1482 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1483 {
1484 unsigned int j;
1485 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1486
1487 /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1488 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1489 files. See below for more details. */
1490 if (oheader == NULL
1491 || (oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1492 && oheader->sh_type < SHT_LOOS))
1493 continue;
1494
1495 /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1496 fields have already been initialised. */
1497 if (oheader->sh_size == 0
1498 || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1499 continue;
1500
1501 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1502 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1503 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1504 {
1505 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1506
1507 if (iheader == NULL)
1508 continue;
1509
1510 if (oheader->bfd_section != NULL
1511 && iheader->bfd_section != NULL
1512 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section != NULL
1513 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section == oheader->bfd_section)
1514 {
1515 /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1516 output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1517 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1518 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1519 if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1520 j = elf_numsections (ibfd);
1521 break;
1522 }
1523 }
1524
1525 if (j < elf_numsections (ibfd))
1526 continue;
1527
1528 /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1529 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1530 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1531 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1532 {
1533 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1534
1535 if (iheader == NULL)
1536 continue;
1537
1538 /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1539 Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1540 SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1541 input type. */
1542 if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1543 || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1544 && (iheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1545 == (oheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1546 && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1547 && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1548 && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1549 && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1550 && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1551 || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1552 {
1553 if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1554 break;
1555 }
1556 }
1557
1558 if (j == elf_numsections (ibfd) && oheader->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS)
1559 {
1560 /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1561 with a NULL input section. */
1562 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL)
1563 bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, NULL, oheader);
1564 }
1565 }
1566
1567 return TRUE;
1568 }
1569
1570 static const char *
1571 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1572 {
1573 const char *pt;
1574 switch (p_type)
1575 {
1576 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1577 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1578 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1579 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1580 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1581 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1582 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1583 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1584 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1585 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1586 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1587 default: pt = NULL; break;
1588 }
1589 return pt;
1590 }
1591
1592 /* Print out the program headers. */
1593
1594 bfd_boolean
1595 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1596 {
1597 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1598 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1599 asection *s;
1600 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1601
1602 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1603 if (p != NULL)
1604 {
1605 unsigned int i, c;
1606
1607 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1608 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1609 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1610 {
1611 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1612 char buf[20];
1613
1614 if (pt == NULL)
1615 {
1616 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1617 pt = buf;
1618 }
1619 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1620 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1621 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1622 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1623 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1624 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1625 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1626 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1627 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1628 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1629 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1630 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1631 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1632 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1633 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1634 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1635 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1636 fprintf (f, "\n");
1637 }
1638 }
1639
1640 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1641 if (s != NULL)
1642 {
1643 unsigned int elfsec;
1644 unsigned long shlink;
1645 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1646 size_t extdynsize;
1647 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1648
1649 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1650
1651 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1652 goto error_return;
1653
1654 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1655 if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1656 goto error_return;
1657 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1658
1659 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1660 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1661
1662 extdyn = dynbuf;
1663 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1664 if (s->size < extdynsize)
1665 goto error_return;
1666 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1667 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1668 Fix range check. */
1669 for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1670 {
1671 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1672 const char *name = "";
1673 char ab[20];
1674 bfd_boolean stringp;
1675 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1676
1677 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1678
1679 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1680 break;
1681
1682 stringp = FALSE;
1683 switch (dyn.d_tag)
1684 {
1685 default:
1686 if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1687 name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1688
1689 if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1690 {
1691 sprintf (ab, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT "x", dyn.d_tag);
1692 name = ab;
1693 }
1694 break;
1695
1696 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1697 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1698 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1699 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1700 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1701 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1702 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1703 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1704 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1705 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1706 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1707 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1708 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1709 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1710 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1711 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1712 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1713 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1714 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1715 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1716 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1717 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1718 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1719 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1720 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1721 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1722 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1723 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1724 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1725 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1726 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1727 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1728 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1729 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1730 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1731 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1732 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1733 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1734 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1735 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1736 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1737 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1738 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1739 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1740 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1741 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1742 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1743 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1744 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1745 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1746 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1747 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1748 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1749 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1750 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1751 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1752 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1753 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1754 }
1755
1756 fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1757 if (! stringp)
1758 {
1759 fprintf (f, "0x");
1760 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1761 }
1762 else
1763 {
1764 const char *string;
1765 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1766
1767 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1768 if (string == NULL)
1769 goto error_return;
1770 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1771 }
1772 fprintf (f, "\n");
1773 }
1774
1775 free (dynbuf);
1776 dynbuf = NULL;
1777 }
1778
1779 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1780 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1781 {
1782 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1783 return FALSE;
1784 }
1785
1786 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1787 {
1788 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1789
1790 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1791 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1792 {
1793 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1794 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1795 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1796 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1797 {
1798 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1799
1800 fprintf (f, "\t");
1801 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1802 a != NULL;
1803 a = a->vda_nextptr)
1804 fprintf (f, "%s ",
1805 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1806 fprintf (f, "\n");
1807 }
1808 }
1809 }
1810
1811 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1812 {
1813 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1814
1815 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1816 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1817 {
1818 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1819
1820 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1821 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1822 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1823 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1824 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1825 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1826 }
1827 }
1828
1829 return TRUE;
1830
1831 error_return:
1832 if (dynbuf != NULL)
1833 free (dynbuf);
1834 return FALSE;
1835 }
1836
1837 /* Get version string. */
1838
1839 const char *
1840 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1841 bfd_boolean *hidden)
1842 {
1843 const char *version_string = NULL;
1844 if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1845 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1846 {
1847 unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1848
1849 *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1850 vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1851
1852 if (vernum == 0)
1853 version_string = "";
1854 else if (vernum == 1)
1855 version_string = "Base";
1856 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1857 version_string =
1858 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1859 else
1860 {
1861 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1862
1863 version_string = "";
1864 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1865 t != NULL;
1866 t = t->vn_nextref)
1867 {
1868 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1869
1870 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1871 {
1872 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1873 {
1874 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1875 break;
1876 }
1877 }
1878 }
1879 }
1880 }
1881 return version_string;
1882 }
1883
1884 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1885
1886 void
1887 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1888 void *filep,
1889 asymbol *symbol,
1890 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1891 {
1892 FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1893 switch (how)
1894 {
1895 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1896 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1897 break;
1898 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1899 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1900 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1901 fprintf (file, " %x", symbol->flags);
1902 break;
1903 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1904 {
1905 const char *section_name;
1906 const char *name = NULL;
1907 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1908 unsigned char st_other;
1909 bfd_vma val;
1910 const char *version_string;
1911 bfd_boolean hidden;
1912
1913 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1914
1915 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1916 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1917 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1918
1919 if (name == NULL)
1920 {
1921 name = symbol->name;
1922 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1923 }
1924
1925 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1926 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1927 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1928 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1929 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1930 if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1931 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1932 else
1933 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1934 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1935
1936 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1937 version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
1938 symbol,
1939 &hidden);
1940 if (version_string)
1941 {
1942 if (!hidden)
1943 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
1944 else
1945 {
1946 int i;
1947
1948 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1949 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1950 putc (' ', file);
1951 }
1952 }
1953
1954 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
1955 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1956
1957 switch (st_other)
1958 {
1959 case 0: break;
1960 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
1961 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
1962 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1963 default:
1964 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1965 everything hex. */
1966 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1967 }
1968
1969 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1970 }
1971 break;
1972 }
1973 }
1974 \f
1975 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1976
1977 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
1978
1979 bfd_boolean
1980 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
1981 {
1982 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
1983 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
1984 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1985 const char *name;
1986 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
1987 static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
1988 static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
1989 static unsigned int nesting = 0;
1990
1991 if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
1992 return FALSE;
1993
1994 if (++ nesting > 3)
1995 {
1996 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
1997 sections, with each the string indicies pointing to the next in the
1998 loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
1999 already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
2000 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
2001 can expect to recurse at least once.
2002
2003 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
2004 rather than being held in a static pointer. */
2005
2006 if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
2007 sections_being_created = NULL;
2008 if (sections_being_created == NULL)
2009 {
2010 /* FIXME: It would be more efficient to attach this array to the bfd somehow. */
2011 sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *)
2012 bfd_zalloc (abfd, elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean));
2013 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2014 }
2015 if (sections_being_created [shindex])
2016 {
2017 _bfd_error_handler
2018 (_("%pB: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
2019 return FALSE;
2020 }
2021 sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
2022 }
2023
2024 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
2025 ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
2026 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
2027 hdr->sh_name);
2028 if (name == NULL)
2029 goto fail;
2030
2031 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2032 switch (hdr->sh_type)
2033 {
2034 case SHT_NULL:
2035 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
2036 goto success;
2037
2038 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
2039 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
2040 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
2041 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
2042 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
2043 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
2044 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
2045 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2046 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2047 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2048 goto success;
2049
2050 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2051 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2052 goto fail;
2053
2054 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
2055 {
2056 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2057 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2058 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
2059 {
2060 case bfd_arch_i386:
2061 case bfd_arch_sparc:
2062 if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2063 || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2064 break;
2065 /* Otherwise fall through. */
2066 default:
2067 goto fail;
2068 }
2069 }
2070 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
2071 goto fail;
2072 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
2073 {
2074 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
2075
2076 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2077 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2078 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2079 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2080 {
2081 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
2082 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2083 }
2084 else
2085 {
2086 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2087
2088 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2089 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2090 {
2091 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2092 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2093 {
2094 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2095 break;
2096 }
2097 }
2098 }
2099 }
2100 goto success;
2101
2102 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
2103 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2104 goto success;
2105
2106 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2107 goto fail;
2108
2109 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2110 {
2111 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2112 goto fail;
2113 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2114 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2115 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2116 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2117 goto success;
2118 }
2119
2120 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2121 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2122 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
2123 {
2124 _bfd_error_handler
2125 /* xgettext:c-format */
2126 (_("%pB: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
2127 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2128 abfd, shindex);
2129 goto success;
2130 }
2131 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2132 elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
2133 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2134 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2135
2136 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2137 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2138 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2139 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2140 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2141 linker. */
2142 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
2143 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
2144 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2145 shindex))
2146 goto fail;
2147
2148 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2149 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2150 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2151 {
2152 elf_section_list * entry;
2153 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2154
2155 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2156 if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
2157 goto success;
2158
2159 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2160 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2161 {
2162 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2163
2164 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2165 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2166 break;
2167 }
2168
2169 if (i == num_sec)
2170 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
2171 {
2172 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2173
2174 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2175 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2176 break;
2177 }
2178
2179 if (i != shindex)
2180 ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
2181 /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2182 goto success;
2183 }
2184
2185 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2186 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2187 goto success;
2188
2189 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2190 goto fail;
2191
2192 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2193 {
2194 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2195 goto fail;
2196
2197 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2198 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2199 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2200 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2201 goto success;
2202 }
2203
2204 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2205 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2206 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2207 {
2208 _bfd_error_handler
2209 /* xgettext:c-format */
2210 (_("%pB: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
2211 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2212 abfd, shindex);
2213 goto success;
2214 }
2215 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2216 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
2217 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
2218 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2219
2220 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2221 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2222 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2223 goto success;
2224
2225 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2226 {
2227 elf_section_list * entry;
2228
2229 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2230 if (entry->ndx == shindex)
2231 goto success;
2232
2233 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
2234 if (entry == NULL)
2235 goto fail;
2236 entry->ndx = shindex;
2237 entry->hdr = * hdr;
2238 entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
2239 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
2240 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
2241 goto success;
2242 }
2243
2244 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
2245 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
2246 goto success;
2247
2248 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
2249 {
2250 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2251 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
2252 goto success;
2253 }
2254
2255 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2256 {
2257 symtab_strtab:
2258 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
2259 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
2260 goto success;
2261 }
2262
2263 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2264 {
2265 dynsymtab_strtab:
2266 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2267 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2268 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2269 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2270 can handle it. */
2271 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2272 shindex);
2273 goto success;
2274 }
2275
2276 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2277 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2278 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2279 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2280 {
2281 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2282
2283 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2284 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2285 {
2286 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2287 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2288 {
2289 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2290 if (i == shindex)
2291 goto fail;
2292 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2293 goto fail;
2294 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2295 goto symtab_strtab;
2296 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2297 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2298 }
2299 }
2300 }
2301 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2302 goto success;
2303
2304 case SHT_REL:
2305 case SHT_RELA:
2306 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2307 {
2308 asection *target_sect;
2309 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
2310 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2311 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
2312
2313 if (hdr->sh_entsize
2314 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2315 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2316 goto fail;
2317
2318 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2319 if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2320 {
2321 _bfd_error_handler
2322 /* xgettext:c-format */
2323 (_("%pB: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2324 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex);
2325 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2326 shindex);
2327 goto success;
2328 }
2329
2330 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2331 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2332 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2333 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2334 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2335 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2336 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2337
2338 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2339 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2340 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2341 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2342 {
2343 unsigned int scan;
2344 int found;
2345
2346 found = 0;
2347 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2348 {
2349 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2350 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2351 {
2352 if (found != 0)
2353 {
2354 found = 0;
2355 break;
2356 }
2357 found = scan;
2358 }
2359 }
2360 if (found != 0)
2361 hdr->sh_link = found;
2362 }
2363
2364 /* Get the symbol table. */
2365 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2366 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2367 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2368 goto fail;
2369
2370 /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
2371 don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't adequately
2372 represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
2373 try. We just present it as a normal section. We also
2374 can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
2375 section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
2376 sh_link points to the null section. */
2377 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2378 || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2379 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2380 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2381 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2382 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2383 {
2384 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2385 shindex);
2386 goto success;
2387 }
2388
2389 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2390 goto fail;
2391
2392 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2393 if (target_sect == NULL)
2394 goto fail;
2395
2396 esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2397 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2398 p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2399 else
2400 p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2401
2402 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7. */
2403 if (*p_hdr != NULL)
2404 goto fail;
2405 hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*hdr2));
2406 if (hdr2 == NULL)
2407 goto fail;
2408 *hdr2 = *hdr;
2409 *p_hdr = hdr2;
2410 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2411 target_sect->reloc_count += (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr)
2412 * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
2413 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2414 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2415 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2416 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2417 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2418 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2419 {
2420 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2421 target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2422 }
2423 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2424 goto success;
2425 }
2426
2427 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2428 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2429 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2430 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2431 goto success;
2432
2433 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2434 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2435 goto fail;
2436
2437 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2438 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2439 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2440 goto success;
2441
2442 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2443 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2444 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2445 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2446 goto success;
2447
2448 case SHT_SHLIB:
2449 goto success;
2450
2451 case SHT_GROUP:
2452 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2453 goto fail;
2454
2455 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2456 goto fail;
2457
2458 goto success;
2459
2460 default:
2461 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2462 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2463 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2464 {
2465 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2466 goto fail;
2467 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2468 goto success;
2469 }
2470
2471 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2472 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2473 goto success;
2474
2475 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2476 {
2477 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2478 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2479 for applications? */
2480 _bfd_error_handler
2481 /* xgettext:c-format */
2482 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2483 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2484 else
2485 {
2486 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2487 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2488 shindex);
2489 goto success;
2490 }
2491 }
2492 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2493 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2494 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2495 _bfd_error_handler
2496 /* xgettext:c-format */
2497 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2498 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2499 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2500 {
2501 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2502 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2503 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2504 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2505 be rejected with an error message. */
2506 _bfd_error_handler
2507 /* xgettext:c-format */
2508 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2509 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2510 else
2511 {
2512 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2513 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2514 goto success;
2515 }
2516 }
2517 else
2518 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2519 _bfd_error_handler
2520 /* xgettext:c-format */
2521 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2522 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2523
2524 goto fail;
2525 }
2526
2527 fail:
2528 ret = FALSE;
2529 success:
2530 if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
2531 sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
2532 if (-- nesting == 0)
2533 {
2534 sections_being_created = NULL;
2535 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2536 }
2537 return ret;
2538 }
2539
2540 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2541
2542 Elf_Internal_Sym *
2543 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2544 bfd *abfd,
2545 unsigned long r_symndx)
2546 {
2547 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2548
2549 if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2550 {
2551 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2552 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2553 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2554
2555 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2556 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2557 &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2558 return NULL;
2559
2560 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2561 {
2562 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2563 cache->abfd = abfd;
2564 }
2565 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2566 }
2567
2568 return &cache->sym[ent];
2569 }
2570
2571 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2572 section. */
2573
2574 asection *
2575 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2576 {
2577 if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2578 return NULL;
2579 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2580 }
2581
2582 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2583 {
2584 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2585 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2586 };
2587
2588 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2589 {
2590 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2591 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2592 };
2593
2594 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2595 {
2596 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2597 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2598 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2599 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2600 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2601 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2602 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2603 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2604 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2605 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2606 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2607 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2608 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2609 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2610 };
2611
2612 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2613 {
2614 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2615 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2616 { NULL, 0 , 0, 0, 0 }
2617 };
2618
2619 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2620 {
2621 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2622 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2623 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2624 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2625 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2626 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2627 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2628 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2629 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2630 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2631 };
2632
2633 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2634 {
2635 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2636 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2637 };
2638
2639 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2640 {
2641 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2642 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2643 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2644 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2645 };
2646
2647 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2648 {
2649 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2650 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2651 };
2652
2653 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2654 {
2655 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2656 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2657 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2658 };
2659
2660 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2661 {
2662 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2663 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2664 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2665 };
2666
2667 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2668 {
2669 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2670 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2671 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2672 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2673 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2674 };
2675
2676 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2677 {
2678 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2679 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2680 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2681 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2682 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2683 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2684 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2685 };
2686
2687 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2688 {
2689 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2690 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2691 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2692 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2693 };
2694
2695 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2696 {
2697 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2698 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2699 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2700 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2701 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2702 };
2703
2704 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2705 {
2706 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2707 special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2708 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2709 NULL, /* 'e' */
2710 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2711 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2712 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2713 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2714 NULL, /* 'j' */
2715 NULL, /* 'k' */
2716 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2717 NULL, /* 'm' */
2718 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2719 NULL, /* 'o' */
2720 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2721 NULL, /* 'q' */
2722 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2723 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2724 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2725 NULL, /* 'u' */
2726 NULL, /* 'v' */
2727 NULL, /* 'w' */
2728 NULL, /* 'x' */
2729 NULL, /* 'y' */
2730 special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2731 };
2732
2733 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2734 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2735 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2736 unsigned int rela)
2737 {
2738 int i;
2739 int len;
2740
2741 len = strlen (name);
2742
2743 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2744 {
2745 int suffix_len;
2746 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2747
2748 if (len < prefix_len)
2749 continue;
2750 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2751 continue;
2752
2753 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2754 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2755 {
2756 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2757 {
2758 if (suffix_len == 0)
2759 continue;
2760 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2761 && (suffix_len == -2
2762 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2763 continue;
2764 }
2765 }
2766 else
2767 {
2768 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2769 continue;
2770 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2771 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2772 suffix_len) != 0)
2773 continue;
2774 }
2775 return &spec[i];
2776 }
2777
2778 return NULL;
2779 }
2780
2781 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2782 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2783 {
2784 int i;
2785 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2786 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2787
2788 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2789 if (sec->name == NULL)
2790 return NULL;
2791
2792 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2793 spec = bed->special_sections;
2794 if (spec)
2795 {
2796 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2797 bed->special_sections,
2798 sec->use_rela_p);
2799 if (spec != NULL)
2800 return spec;
2801 }
2802
2803 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2804 return NULL;
2805
2806 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2807 if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2808 return NULL;
2809
2810 spec = special_sections[i];
2811
2812 if (spec == NULL)
2813 return NULL;
2814
2815 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2816 }
2817
2818 bfd_boolean
2819 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2820 {
2821 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2822 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2823 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2824
2825 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2826 if (sdata == NULL)
2827 {
2828 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2829 sizeof (*sdata));
2830 if (sdata == NULL)
2831 return FALSE;
2832 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2833 }
2834
2835 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2836 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2837 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2838
2839 /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2840 flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2841 anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2842 created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2843 set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2844 elf_fake_sections. Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
2845 output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
2846 sections. We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
2847 copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections. */
2848 if (abfd->direction != read_direction
2849 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2850 {
2851 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2852 if (ssect != NULL
2853 && (!sec->flags
2854 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
2855 || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
2856 || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
2857 {
2858 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2859 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2860 }
2861 }
2862
2863 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2864 }
2865
2866 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2867
2868 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2869 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2870 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2871 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2872
2873 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2874 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2875 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2876 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2877 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2878 of combined data+bss.
2879
2880 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2881 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2882 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2883 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2884 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2885
2886 */
2887
2888 bfd_boolean
2889 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2890 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2891 int hdr_index,
2892 const char *type_name)
2893 {
2894 asection *newsect;
2895 char *name;
2896 char namebuf[64];
2897 size_t len;
2898 int split;
2899
2900 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2901 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2902 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2903
2904 if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2905 {
2906 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2907 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2908 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2909 if (!name)
2910 return FALSE;
2911 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2912 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2913 if (newsect == NULL)
2914 return FALSE;
2915 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2916 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2917 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2918 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2919 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2920 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2921 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2922 {
2923 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2924 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2925 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2926 {
2927 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2928 may be data. */
2929 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2930 }
2931 }
2932 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2933 {
2934 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2935 }
2936 }
2937
2938 if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2939 {
2940 bfd_vma align;
2941
2942 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2943 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2944 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2945 if (!name)
2946 return FALSE;
2947 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2948 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2949 if (newsect == NULL)
2950 return FALSE;
2951 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2952 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2953 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2954 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
2955 align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
2956 if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
2957 align = hdr->p_align;
2958 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
2959 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2960 {
2961 /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
2962 not have their contents written to a core file, on the
2963 assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
2964 executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
2965 section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
2966 always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
2967 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
2968 newsect->size = 0;
2969 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2970 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2971 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2972 }
2973 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2974 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2975 }
2976
2977 return TRUE;
2978 }
2979
2980 bfd_boolean
2981 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
2982 {
2983 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2984
2985 switch (hdr->p_type)
2986 {
2987 case PT_NULL:
2988 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
2989
2990 case PT_LOAD:
2991 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
2992
2993 case PT_DYNAMIC:
2994 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
2995
2996 case PT_INTERP:
2997 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
2998
2999 case PT_NOTE:
3000 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
3001 return FALSE;
3002 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz,
3003 hdr->p_align))
3004 return FALSE;
3005 return TRUE;
3006
3007 case PT_SHLIB:
3008 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
3009
3010 case PT_PHDR:
3011 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
3012
3013 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
3014 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
3015 "eh_frame_hdr");
3016
3017 case PT_GNU_STACK:
3018 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
3019
3020 case PT_GNU_RELRO:
3021 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
3022
3023 default:
3024 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3025 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3026 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
3027 }
3028 }
3029
3030 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3031 REL or RELA. */
3032
3033 Elf_Internal_Shdr *
3034 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
3035 {
3036 if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
3037 {
3038 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
3039 return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
3040 }
3041 else
3042 return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
3043 }
3044
3045 static bfd_boolean
3046 _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
3047 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
3048 const char *sec_name,
3049 bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
3050 {
3051 char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
3052 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
3053 if (name == NULL)
3054 return FALSE;
3055
3056 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
3057 rel_hdr->sh_name =
3058 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
3059 FALSE);
3060 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3061 return FALSE;
3062
3063 return TRUE;
3064 }
3065
3066 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3067 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3068 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3069 relocations. */
3070
3071 static bfd_boolean
3072 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
3073 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
3074 const char *sec_name,
3075 bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
3076 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
3077 {
3078 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
3079 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3080
3081 BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
3082 rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*rel_hdr));
3083 reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
3084
3085 if (delay_st_name_p)
3086 rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3087 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
3088 use_rela_p))
3089 return FALSE;
3090 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
3091 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
3092 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
3093 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
3094 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
3095 rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3096 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3097 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3098 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3099
3100 return TRUE;
3101 }
3102
3103 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3104
3105 int
3106 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
3107 {
3108 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3109 && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
3110 return SHT_NOBITS;
3111 return SHT_PROGBITS;
3112 }
3113
3114 struct fake_section_arg
3115 {
3116 struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
3117 bfd_boolean failed;
3118 };
3119
3120 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3121
3122 static void
3123 elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
3124 {
3125 struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
3126 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3127 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
3128 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
3129 unsigned int sh_type;
3130 const char *name = asect->name;
3131 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
3132
3133 if (arg->failed)
3134 {
3135 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3136 loop. */
3137 return;
3138 }
3139
3140 this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
3141
3142 if (arg->link_info)
3143 {
3144 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3145 if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
3146 && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
3147 && name[1] == 'd'
3148 && name[6] == '_')
3149 {
3150 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3151 compressed. */
3152 asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
3153
3154 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3155 name to section name section after it is compressed in
3156 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3157 delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
3158 }
3159 }
3160 else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
3161 {
3162 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3163 if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
3164 {
3165 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3166 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3167 needed. */
3168 if (name[1] == 'z')
3169 {
3170 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
3171 if (new_name == NULL)
3172 {
3173 arg->failed = TRUE;
3174 return;
3175 }
3176 name = new_name;
3177 }
3178 }
3179 else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
3180 {
3181 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3182 section smaller. So only rename the section when
3183 compression has actually taken place. If input section
3184 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3185 char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
3186 if (new_name == NULL)
3187 {
3188 arg->failed = TRUE;
3189 return;
3190 }
3191 BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
3192 name = new_name;
3193 }
3194 }
3195
3196 if (delay_st_name_p)
3197 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3198 else
3199 {
3200 this_hdr->sh_name
3201 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3202 name, FALSE);
3203 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3204 {
3205 arg->failed = TRUE;
3206 return;
3207 }
3208 }
3209
3210 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3211
3212 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3213 || asect->user_set_vma)
3214 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
3215 else
3216 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3217
3218 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3219 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
3220 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3221 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3222 if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
3223 {
3224 _bfd_error_handler
3225 /* xgettext:c-format */
3226 (_("%pB: error: alignment power %d of section `%pA' is too big"),
3227 abfd, asect->alignment_power, asect);
3228 arg->failed = TRUE;
3229 return;
3230 }
3231 this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
3232 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3233 copy_private_section_data. */
3234
3235 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
3236 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
3237
3238 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3239 asect->flags. */
3240 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
3241 sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
3242 else
3243 sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
3244
3245 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
3246 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3247 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
3248 && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
3249 && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3250 {
3251 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3252 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3253 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3254 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3255 _bfd_error_handler
3256 (_("warning: section `%pA' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
3257 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3258 }
3259
3260 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
3261 {
3262 default:
3263 break;
3264
3265 case SHT_STRTAB:
3266 case SHT_NOTE:
3267 case SHT_NOBITS:
3268 case SHT_PROGBITS:
3269 break;
3270
3271 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
3272 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
3273 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
3274 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
3275 break;
3276
3277 case SHT_HASH:
3278 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
3279 break;
3280
3281 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3282 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
3283 break;
3284
3285 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3286 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
3287 break;
3288
3289 case SHT_RELA:
3290 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
3291 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3292 break;
3293
3294 case SHT_REL:
3295 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
3296 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3297 break;
3298
3299 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3300 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3301 break;
3302
3303 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3304 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3305 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3306 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3307 zero. */
3308 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3309 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3310 else
3311 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3312 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3313 break;
3314
3315 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3316 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3317 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3318 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3319 zero. */
3320 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3321 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3322 else
3323 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3324 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3325 break;
3326
3327 case SHT_GROUP:
3328 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3329 break;
3330
3331 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3332 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3333 break;
3334 }
3335
3336 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3337 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3338 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3339 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3340 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3341 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3342 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3343 {
3344 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3345 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3346 }
3347 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3348 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3349 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3350 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3351 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3352 {
3353 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3354 if (asect->size == 0
3355 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3356 {
3357 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3358
3359 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3360 if (o != NULL)
3361 {
3362 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3363 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3364 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3365 }
3366 }
3367 }
3368 if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3369 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3370
3371 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3372 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3373 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3374 create the other. */
3375 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3376 {
3377 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3378 needed. */
3379 if (arg->link_info
3380 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3381 && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3382 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3383 || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3384 {
3385 if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3386 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name,
3387 FALSE, delay_st_name_p))
3388 {
3389 arg->failed = TRUE;
3390 return;
3391 }
3392 if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3393 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name,
3394 TRUE, delay_st_name_p))
3395 {
3396 arg->failed = TRUE;
3397 return;
3398 }
3399 }
3400 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3401 (asect->use_rela_p
3402 ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3403 name,
3404 asect->use_rela_p,
3405 delay_st_name_p))
3406 {
3407 arg->failed = TRUE;
3408 return;
3409 }
3410 }
3411
3412 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3413 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3414 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3415 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3416 {
3417 arg->failed = TRUE;
3418 return;
3419 }
3420
3421 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3422 {
3423 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3424 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3425 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3426 }
3427 }
3428
3429 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3430 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3431 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3432 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3433
3434 void
3435 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3436 {
3437 bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
3438 asection *elt, *first;
3439 unsigned char *loc;
3440 bfd_boolean gas;
3441
3442 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3443 elfxx-ia64.c. */
3444 if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
3445 || *failedptr)
3446 return;
3447
3448 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3449 {
3450 unsigned long symindx = 0;
3451
3452 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3453 generic linker. */
3454 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3455 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3456
3457 if (symindx == 0)
3458 {
3459 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3460 elf_section_syms. */
3461 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
3462 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3463 }
3464 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3465 }
3466 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3467 {
3468 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3469 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3470 set until all local symbols are output. */
3471 asection *igroup;
3472 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data;
3473 unsigned long symndx;
3474 unsigned long extsymoff;
3475 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3476
3477 /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3478 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3479 the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3480 igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3481 sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3482 symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3483 extsymoff = 0;
3484 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3485 {
3486 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3487
3488 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3489 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3490 }
3491 h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3492 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3493 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3494 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3495
3496 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3497 }
3498
3499 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3500 gas = TRUE;
3501 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3502 {
3503 gas = FALSE;
3504 sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3505
3506 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3507 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3508 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3509 {
3510 *failedptr = TRUE;
3511 return;
3512 }
3513 }
3514
3515 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3516
3517 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3518 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3519 start of the input section group. */
3520 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3521
3522 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3523 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3524 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3525 directives, not that it matters. */
3526 while (elt != NULL)
3527 {
3528 asection *s;
3529
3530 s = elt;
3531 if (!gas)
3532 s = s->output_section;
3533 if (s != NULL
3534 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3535 {
3536 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
3537 struct bfd_elf_section_data *input_elf_sec = elf_section_data (elt);
3538
3539 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3540 && (gas
3541 || (input_elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3542 && input_elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3543 {
3544 elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3545 loc -= 4;
3546 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rel.idx, loc);
3547 }
3548 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3549 && (gas
3550 || (input_elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3551 && input_elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3552 {
3553 elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3554 loc -= 4;
3555 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rela.idx, loc);
3556 }
3557 loc -= 4;
3558 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->this_idx, loc);
3559 }
3560 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3561 if (elt == first)
3562 break;
3563 }
3564
3565 loc -= 4;
3566 BFD_ASSERT (loc == sec->contents);
3567
3568 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3569 }
3570
3571 /* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
3572 .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
3573 relocations apply. */
3574
3575 asection *
3576 _bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
3577 {
3578 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3579 section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section. */
3580 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3581 && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3582 {
3583 asection *sec;
3584
3585 name = ".got.plt";
3586 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3587 if (sec != NULL)
3588 return sec;
3589 name = ".got";
3590 }
3591
3592 return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3593 }
3594
3595 /* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies. */
3596
3597 static asection *
3598 elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3599 {
3600 const char *name;
3601 unsigned int type;
3602 bfd *abfd;
3603 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3604
3605 type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3606 if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3607 return NULL;
3608
3609 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3610 name = reloc_sec->name;
3611 if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) != 0)
3612 return NULL;
3613 name += 4;
3614 if (type == SHT_RELA && *name++ != 'a')
3615 return NULL;
3616
3617 abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3618 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3619 return bed->get_reloc_section (abfd, name);
3620 }
3621
3622 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3623 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3624 in here too, while we're at it. */
3625
3626 static bfd_boolean
3627 assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3628 {
3629 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3630 asection *sec;
3631 unsigned int section_number;
3632 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3633 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3634 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3635
3636 section_number = 1;
3637
3638 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3639
3640 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3641 if (link_info == NULL || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
3642 {
3643 size_t reloc_count = 0;
3644
3645 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3646 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3647 {
3648 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3649
3650 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3651 {
3652 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3653 {
3654 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3655 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3656 abfd->section_count--;
3657 }
3658 else
3659 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3660 }
3661
3662 /* Count relocations. */
3663 reloc_count += sec->reloc_count;
3664 }
3665
3666 /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3667 if (reloc_count == 0)
3668 abfd->flags &= ~HAS_RELOC;
3669 }
3670
3671 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3672 {
3673 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3674
3675 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3676 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3677 if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3678 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3679 if (d->rel.hdr)
3680 {
3681 d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3682 if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3683 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3684 }
3685 else
3686 d->rel.idx = 0;
3687
3688 if (d->rela.hdr)
3689 {
3690 d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3691 if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3692 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3693 }
3694 else
3695 d->rela.idx = 0;
3696 }
3697
3698 need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3699 || (link_info == NULL
3700 && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3701 == HAS_RELOC)));
3702 if (need_symtab)
3703 {
3704 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3705 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3706 if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3707 {
3708 elf_section_list * entry;
3709
3710 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
3711
3712 entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
3713 entry->ndx = section_number++;
3714 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
3715 entry->hdr.sh_name
3716 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3717 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3718 if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3719 return FALSE;
3720 }
3721 elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3722 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3723 }
3724
3725 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3726 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3727 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3728
3729 if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3730 {
3731 /* xgettext:c-format */
3732 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: too many sections: %u"),
3733 abfd, section_number);
3734 return FALSE;
3735 }
3736
3737 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3738 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3739
3740 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3741 indices. */
3742 i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
3743 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3744 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3745 return FALSE;
3746
3747 i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3748 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3749 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3750 {
3751 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3752 return FALSE;
3753 }
3754
3755 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3756
3757 i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3758 if (need_symtab)
3759 {
3760 i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3761 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3762 {
3763 elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
3764 BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
3765 i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
3766 entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3767 }
3768 i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3769 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3770 }
3771
3772 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3773 {
3774 asection *s;
3775
3776 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3777
3778 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3779 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3780 i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3781 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3782 i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3783
3784 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3785
3786 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3787 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3788 the relocation entries apply. */
3789 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3790 {
3791 d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3792 d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3793 d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3794 }
3795 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3796 {
3797 d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3798 d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3799 d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3800 }
3801
3802 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3803 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3804 {
3805 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3806 if (s)
3807 {
3808 /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3809 if (link_info != NULL)
3810 {
3811 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3812 if (discarded_section (s))
3813 {
3814 asection *kept;
3815 _bfd_error_handler
3816 /* xgettext:c-format */
3817 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3818 " discarded section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3819 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3820 s, s->owner);
3821 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3822 size as the discarded one. */
3823 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3824 if (kept == NULL)
3825 {
3826 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3827 return FALSE;
3828 }
3829 s = kept;
3830 }
3831
3832 s = s->output_section;
3833 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3834 }
3835 else
3836 {
3837 /* Handle objcopy. */
3838 if (s->output_section == NULL)
3839 {
3840 _bfd_error_handler
3841 /* xgettext:c-format */
3842 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3843 " removed section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3844 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3845 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3846 return FALSE;
3847 }
3848 s = s->output_section;
3849 }
3850 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3851 }
3852 else
3853 {
3854 /* PR 290:
3855 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3856 SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3857 sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3858 where s is NULL. */
3859 const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3860 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3861 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3862 bed->link_order_error_handler
3863 /* xgettext:c-format */
3864 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
3865 abfd, sec);
3866 }
3867 }
3868
3869 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3870 {
3871 case SHT_REL:
3872 case SHT_RELA:
3873 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3874 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3875 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3876 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3877 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3878 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3879 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3880 if (s != NULL)
3881 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3882
3883 s = elf_get_reloc_section (sec);
3884 if (s != NULL)
3885 {
3886 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3887 d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3888 }
3889 break;
3890
3891 case SHT_STRTAB:
3892 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3893 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3894 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3895 field to point to this section. */
3896 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3897 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3898 {
3899 size_t len;
3900 char *alc;
3901
3902 len = strlen (sec->name);
3903 alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3904 if (alc == NULL)
3905 return FALSE;
3906 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3907 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3908 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3909 free (alc);
3910 if (s != NULL)
3911 {
3912 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3913
3914 /* This is a .stab section. */
3915 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3916 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3917 = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3918 }
3919 }
3920 break;
3921
3922 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3923 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3924 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3925 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3926 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3927 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3928 version strings. */
3929 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3930 if (s != NULL)
3931 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3932 break;
3933
3934 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3935 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3936 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3937 the version strings. */
3938 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3939 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3940 if (s != NULL)
3941 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3942 break;
3943
3944 case SHT_HASH:
3945 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3946 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3947 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3948 this hash table or version table is for. */
3949 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3950 if (s != NULL)
3951 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3952 break;
3953
3954 case SHT_GROUP:
3955 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3956 }
3957 }
3958
3959 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
3960 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
3961 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
3962
3963 return TRUE;
3964 }
3965
3966 static bfd_boolean
3967 sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3968 {
3969 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
3970 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3971 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3972 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3973
3974 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
3975 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3976 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3977 }
3978
3979 /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
3980 SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
3981 SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
3982 the beginning of that array.
3983
3984 Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
3985
3986 unsigned int
3987 _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3988 asymbol **syms, long symcount)
3989 {
3990 long src_count, dst_count = 0;
3991
3992 for (src_count = 0; src_count < symcount; src_count++)
3993 {
3994 asymbol *sym = syms[src_count];
3995 char *name = (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym);
3996 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
3997
3998 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3999 continue;
4000
4001 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
4002 if (h == NULL)
4003 continue;
4004 if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4005 continue;
4006 if (h->linker_def || h->ldscript_def)
4007 continue;
4008
4009 syms[dst_count++] = sym;
4010 }
4011
4012 syms[dst_count] = NULL;
4013
4014 return dst_count;
4015 }
4016
4017 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
4018 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
4019
4020 static bfd_boolean
4021 ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4022 {
4023 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
4024
4025 if (sym == NULL)
4026 return FALSE;
4027
4028 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
4029 return FALSE;
4030
4031 if (sym->section == NULL)
4032 return TRUE;
4033
4034 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
4035 return ((type_ptr != NULL
4036 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
4037 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4038 || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
4039 || (sym->section->output_section != NULL
4040 && sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
4041 && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
4042 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
4043 }
4044
4045 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
4046 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
4047
4048 static bfd_boolean
4049 elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
4050 {
4051 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
4052 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
4053 asymbol **sect_syms;
4054 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
4055 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
4056 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
4057 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
4058 unsigned int max_index = 0;
4059 unsigned int idx;
4060 asection *asect;
4061 asymbol **new_syms;
4062
4063 #ifdef DEBUG
4064 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4065 fflush (stderr);
4066 #endif
4067
4068 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4069 {
4070 if (max_index < asect->index)
4071 max_index = asect->index;
4072 }
4073
4074 max_index++;
4075 sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
4076 if (sect_syms == NULL)
4077 return FALSE;
4078 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
4079 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
4080
4081 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4082 decided to output. */
4083 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4084 {
4085 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4086
4087 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
4088 && sym->value == 0
4089 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4090 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4091 {
4092 asection *sec = sym->section;
4093
4094 if (sec->owner != abfd)
4095 sec = sec->output_section;
4096
4097 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
4098 }
4099 }
4100
4101 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4102 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4103 {
4104 if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
4105 num_globals++;
4106 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
4107 num_locals++;
4108 }
4109
4110 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4111 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4112 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4113 at least in that case. */
4114 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4115 {
4116 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4117 {
4118 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
4119 num_locals++;
4120 else
4121 num_globals++;
4122 }
4123 }
4124
4125 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4126 new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
4127 sizeof (asymbol *));
4128
4129 if (new_syms == NULL)
4130 return FALSE;
4131
4132 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4133 {
4134 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4135 unsigned int i;
4136
4137 if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4138 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4139 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
4140 i = num_locals2++;
4141 else
4142 continue;
4143 new_syms[i] = sym;
4144 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4145 }
4146 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4147 {
4148 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4149 {
4150 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4151 unsigned int i;
4152
4153 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
4154 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4155 i = num_locals2++;
4156 else
4157 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4158 new_syms[i] = sym;
4159 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4160 }
4161 }
4162
4163 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
4164
4165 *pnum_locals = num_locals;
4166 return TRUE;
4167 }
4168
4169 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4170 ELF data structure. */
4171
4172 static inline file_ptr
4173 align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
4174 {
4175 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
4176 }
4177
4178 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4179 required section alignment. */
4180
4181 file_ptr
4182 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
4183 file_ptr offset,
4184 bfd_boolean align)
4185 {
4186 if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
4187 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
4188 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
4189 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
4190 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
4191 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4192 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
4193 return offset;
4194 }
4195
4196 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4197 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4198 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4199
4200 bfd_boolean
4201 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
4202 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4203 {
4204 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4205 struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
4206 bfd_boolean failed;
4207 struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
4208 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
4209 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
4210
4211 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
4212 return TRUE;
4213
4214 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4215 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
4216 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
4217
4218 if (! prep_headers (abfd))
4219 return FALSE;
4220
4221 /* Post process the headers if necessary. */
4222 (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
4223
4224 fsargs.failed = FALSE;
4225 fsargs.link_info = link_info;
4226 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
4227 if (fsargs.failed)
4228 return FALSE;
4229
4230 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
4231 return FALSE;
4232
4233 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4234 need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
4235 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
4236 || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
4237 == HAS_RELOC)));
4238 if (need_symtab)
4239 {
4240 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4241 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
4242
4243 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
4244 return FALSE;
4245 }
4246
4247 failed = FALSE;
4248 if (link_info == NULL)
4249 {
4250 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
4251 if (failed)
4252 return FALSE;
4253 }
4254
4255 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
4256 /* sh_name was set in prep_headers. */
4257 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
4258 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
4259 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
4260 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4261 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4262 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
4263 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
4264 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4265 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
4266
4267 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
4268 return FALSE;
4269
4270 if (need_symtab)
4271 {
4272 file_ptr off;
4273 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4274
4275 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
4276
4277 hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4278 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4279
4280 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
4281 {
4282 hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
4283 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4284 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4285 /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4286 }
4287
4288 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
4289 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4290
4291 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
4292
4293 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4294 out. */
4295 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
4296 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
4297 return FALSE;
4298 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
4299 }
4300
4301 abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
4302
4303 return TRUE;
4304 }
4305
4306 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4307 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4308
4309 static bfd_size_type
4310 get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4311 {
4312 size_t segs;
4313 asection *s;
4314 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4315
4316 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4317 and one for data. */
4318 segs = 2;
4319
4320 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4321 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4322 {
4323 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
4324 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
4325 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
4326 targets. */
4327 segs += 2;
4328 }
4329
4330 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
4331 {
4332 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4333 ++segs;
4334 }
4335
4336 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4337 {
4338 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4339 ++segs;
4340 }
4341
4342 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
4343 {
4344 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4345 ++segs;
4346 }
4347
4348 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4349 {
4350 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4351 ++segs;
4352 }
4353
4354 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4355 {
4356 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4357 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4358 {
4359 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4360 ++segs;
4361 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
4362 for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
4363 gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
4364 (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4365 each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
4366 so we check whether the sections are correctly
4367 aligned. */
4368 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4369 while (s->next != NULL
4370 && s->next->alignment_power == 2
4371 && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4372 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
4373 s = s->next;
4374 }
4375 }
4376
4377 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4378 {
4379 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4380 {
4381 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4382 ++segs;
4383 break;
4384 }
4385 }
4386
4387 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4388
4389 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4390 {
4391 /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4392 unsigned int page_align_power = bfd_log2 (bed->commonpagesize);
4393 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4394 if (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
4395 {
4396 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4397 > PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
4398 {
4399 _bfd_error_handler
4400 /* xgettext:c-format */
4401 (_("%pB: GNU_MBIN section `%pA' has invalid sh_info field: %d"),
4402 abfd, s, elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4403 continue;
4404 }
4405 /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4406 if (s->alignment_power < page_align_power)
4407 s->alignment_power = page_align_power;
4408 segs ++;
4409 }
4410 }
4411
4412 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4413 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
4414 {
4415 int a;
4416
4417 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
4418 if (a == -1)
4419 abort ();
4420 segs += a;
4421 }
4422
4423 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4424 }
4425
4426 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4427
4428 Elf_Internal_Phdr *
4429 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
4430 {
4431 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4432 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4433
4434 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4435 m != NULL;
4436 m = m->next, p++)
4437 {
4438 int i;
4439
4440 for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4441 if (m->sections[i] == section)
4442 return p;
4443 }
4444
4445 return NULL;
4446 }
4447
4448 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4449
4450 static struct elf_segment_map *
4451 make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4452 asection **sections,
4453 unsigned int from,
4454 unsigned int to,
4455 bfd_boolean phdr)
4456 {
4457 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4458 unsigned int i;
4459 asection **hdrpp;
4460 bfd_size_type amt;
4461
4462 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4463 amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4464 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4465 if (m == NULL)
4466 return NULL;
4467 m->next = NULL;
4468 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4469 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4470 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4471 m->count = to - from;
4472
4473 if (from == 0 && phdr)
4474 {
4475 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4476 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4477 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4478 }
4479
4480 return m;
4481 }
4482
4483 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4484 on failure. */
4485
4486 struct elf_segment_map *
4487 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4488 {
4489 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4490
4491 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4492 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4493 if (m == NULL)
4494 return NULL;
4495 m->next = NULL;
4496 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4497 m->count = 1;
4498 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4499
4500 return m;
4501 }
4502
4503 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4504
4505 static bfd_boolean
4506 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4507 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4508 bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
4509 {
4510 struct elf_segment_map **m;
4511 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4512
4513 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4514 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4515 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4516 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4517 removed. */
4518 m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4519 while (*m)
4520 {
4521 unsigned int i, new_count;
4522
4523 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4524 {
4525 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4526 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4527 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4528 {
4529 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4530 new_count++;
4531 }
4532 }
4533 (*m)->count = new_count;
4534
4535 if (remove_empty_load
4536 && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD
4537 && (*m)->count == 0
4538 && !(*m)->includes_phdrs)
4539 *m = (*m)->next;
4540 else
4541 m = &(*m)->next;
4542 }
4543
4544 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4545 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4546 {
4547 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4548 return FALSE;
4549 }
4550
4551 return TRUE;
4552 }
4553
4554 #define IS_TBSS(s) \
4555 ((s->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) == SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4556
4557 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4558
4559 bfd_boolean
4560 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4561 {
4562 unsigned int count;
4563 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4564 asection **sections = NULL;
4565 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4566 bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
4567
4568 no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4569
4570 if (info != NULL)
4571 info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4572
4573 if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4574 {
4575 asection *s;
4576 unsigned int i;
4577 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4578 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4579 asection *last_hdr;
4580 bfd_vma last_size;
4581 unsigned int phdr_index;
4582 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4583 asection **hdrpp;
4584 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4585 bfd_boolean writable;
4586 bfd_boolean executable;
4587 int tls_count = 0;
4588 asection *first_tls = NULL;
4589 asection *first_mbind = NULL;
4590 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4591 bfd_size_type amt;
4592 bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
4593 bfd_boolean linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = FALSE;
4594
4595 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4596
4597 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
4598 sizeof (asection *));
4599 if (sections == NULL)
4600 goto error_return;
4601
4602 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4603 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4604 being shifted. */
4605 addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4606 addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4607
4608 i = 0;
4609 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4610 {
4611 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4612 {
4613 sections[i] = s;
4614 ++i;
4615 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4616 if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4617 wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
4618 }
4619 }
4620 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4621 count = i;
4622
4623 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4624
4625 /* Build the mapping. */
4626
4627 mfirst = NULL;
4628 pm = &mfirst;
4629
4630 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4631 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4632 section. */
4633 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4634 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4635 {
4636 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4637 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4638 if (m == NULL)
4639 goto error_return;
4640 m->next = NULL;
4641 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4642 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4643 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4644 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4645 linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = TRUE;
4646 *pm = m;
4647 pm = &m->next;
4648
4649 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4650 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4651 if (m == NULL)
4652 goto error_return;
4653 m->next = NULL;
4654 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4655 m->count = 1;
4656 m->sections[0] = s;
4657
4658 *pm = m;
4659 pm = &m->next;
4660 }
4661
4662 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4663 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4664 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4665 last_hdr = NULL;
4666 last_size = 0;
4667 phdr_index = 0;
4668 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4669 /* PR 17512: file: c8455299.
4670 Avoid divide-by-zero errors later on.
4671 FIXME: Should we abort if the maxpagesize is zero ? */
4672 if (maxpagesize == 0)
4673 maxpagesize = 1;
4674 writable = FALSE;
4675 executable = FALSE;
4676 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4677 if (dynsec != NULL
4678 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4679 dynsec = NULL;
4680
4681 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4682 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4683 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4684 program headers we will need. */
4685 if (count > 0)
4686 {
4687 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4688
4689 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4690 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4691 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4692 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4693 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
4694 || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
4695 < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
4696 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
4697 {
4698 /* PR 20815: The ELF standard says that a PT_PHDR segment, if
4699 present, must be included as part of the memory image of the
4700 program. Ie it must be part of a PT_LOAD segment as well.
4701 If we have had to create our own PT_PHDR segment, but it is
4702 not going to be covered by the first PT_LOAD segment, then
4703 force the inclusion if we can... */
4704 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4705 && linker_created_pt_phdr_segment)
4706 phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4707 else
4708 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4709 }
4710 }
4711
4712 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4713 {
4714 asection *hdr;
4715 bfd_boolean new_segment;
4716
4717 hdr = *hdrpp;
4718
4719 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4720 segment. */
4721
4722 if (last_hdr == NULL)
4723 {
4724 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4725 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4726 new_segment = FALSE;
4727 }
4728 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4729 {
4730 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4731 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4732 segment. */
4733 new_segment = TRUE;
4734 }
4735 else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4736 || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4737 {
4738 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4739 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4740 new_segment = TRUE;
4741 }
4742 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4743 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4744 == (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4745 {
4746 /* If we are demand paged then we can't map two disk
4747 pages onto the same memory page. */
4748 new_segment = FALSE;
4749 }
4750 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4751 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4752 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4753 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4754 section can be included in the current segment. */
4755 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4756 + maxpagesize > last_hdr->lma)
4757 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4758 + maxpagesize <= hdr->lma))
4759 {
4760 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4761 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4762 new_segment = TRUE;
4763 }
4764 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4765 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
4766 {
4767 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4768 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4769 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4770 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose. */
4771 new_segment = TRUE;
4772 }
4773 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4774 {
4775 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4776 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4777 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4778 new_segment = FALSE;
4779 }
4780 else if (info != NULL
4781 && info->separate_code
4782 && executable != ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0))
4783 {
4784 new_segment = TRUE;
4785 }
4786 else if (! writable
4787 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4788 {
4789 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4790 segment. */
4791 new_segment = TRUE;
4792 }
4793 else
4794 {
4795 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4796 new_segment = FALSE;
4797 }
4798
4799 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4800 if (last_hdr != NULL
4801 && info != NULL
4802 && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4803 new_segment
4804 = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4805 last_hdr,
4806 new_segment);
4807
4808 if (! new_segment)
4809 {
4810 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4811 writable = TRUE;
4812 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4813 executable = TRUE;
4814 last_hdr = hdr;
4815 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4816 last_size = !IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0;
4817 continue;
4818 }
4819
4820 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4821 header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr. */
4822
4823 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4824 if (m == NULL)
4825 goto error_return;
4826
4827 *pm = m;
4828 pm = &m->next;
4829
4830 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4831 writable = TRUE;
4832 else
4833 writable = FALSE;
4834
4835 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
4836 executable = FALSE;
4837 else
4838 executable = TRUE;
4839
4840 last_hdr = hdr;
4841 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4842 last_size = !IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0;
4843 phdr_index = i;
4844 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4845 }
4846
4847 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4848 for .tbss. */
4849 if (last_hdr != NULL
4850 && (i - phdr_index != 1
4851 || !IS_TBSS (last_hdr)))
4852 {
4853 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4854 if (m == NULL)
4855 goto error_return;
4856
4857 *pm = m;
4858 pm = &m->next;
4859 }
4860
4861 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4862 if (dynsec != NULL)
4863 {
4864 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4865 if (m == NULL)
4866 goto error_return;
4867 *pm = m;
4868 pm = &m->next;
4869 }
4870
4871 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
4872 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4873 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4874 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4875 in the output file. FIXME: Using names for section types is
4876 bogus anyhow. */
4877 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4878 {
4879 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4880 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4881 {
4882 asection *s2;
4883
4884 count = 1;
4885 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4886 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4887 for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
4888 {
4889 if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
4890 && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4891 && CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
4892 && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
4893 == s2->next->lma)
4894 count++;
4895 else
4896 break;
4897 }
4898 amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4899 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4900 if (m == NULL)
4901 goto error_return;
4902 m->next = NULL;
4903 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4904 m->count = count;
4905 while (count > 1)
4906 {
4907 m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
4908 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4909 s = s->next;
4910 }
4911 m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
4912 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4913 *pm = m;
4914 pm = &m->next;
4915 }
4916 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4917 {
4918 if (! tls_count)
4919 first_tls = s;
4920 tls_count++;
4921 }
4922 if (first_mbind == NULL
4923 && (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
4924 first_mbind = s;
4925 }
4926
4927 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
4928 if (tls_count > 0)
4929 {
4930 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4931 amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4932 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4933 if (m == NULL)
4934 goto error_return;
4935 m->next = NULL;
4936 m->p_type = PT_TLS;
4937 m->count = tls_count;
4938 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4939 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4940 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4941 s = first_tls;
4942 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
4943 {
4944 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
4945 {
4946 _bfd_error_handler
4947 (_("%pB: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
4948 s = first_tls;
4949 i = 0;
4950 while (i < (unsigned int) tls_count)
4951 {
4952 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
4953 {
4954 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %pA"), s);
4955 i++;
4956 }
4957 else
4958 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %pA"), s);
4959 s = s->next;
4960 }
4961 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4962 goto error_return;
4963 }
4964 m->sections[i] = s;
4965 s = s->next;
4966 }
4967
4968 *pm = m;
4969 pm = &m->next;
4970 }
4971
4972 if (first_mbind && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4973 for (s = first_mbind; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4974 if ((elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0
4975 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4976 <= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM))
4977 {
4978 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4979 unsigned long p_flags = PF_R;
4980 if ((s->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4981 p_flags |= PF_W;
4982 if ((s->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4983 p_flags |= PF_X;
4984
4985 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
4986 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4987 if (m == NULL)
4988 goto error_return;
4989 m->next = NULL;
4990 m->p_type = (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
4991 + elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4992 m->count = 1;
4993 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4994 m->sections[0] = s;
4995 m->p_flags = p_flags;
4996
4997 *pm = m;
4998 pm = &m->next;
4999 }
5000
5001 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
5002 segment. */
5003 eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
5004 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
5005 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
5006 {
5007 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5008 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5009 if (m == NULL)
5010 goto error_return;
5011 m->next = NULL;
5012 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
5013 m->count = 1;
5014 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
5015
5016 *pm = m;
5017 pm = &m->next;
5018 }
5019
5020 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
5021 {
5022 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5023 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5024 if (m == NULL)
5025 goto error_return;
5026 m->next = NULL;
5027 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
5028 m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
5029 m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
5030 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5031 m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
5032 if (info->stacksize > 0)
5033 {
5034 m->p_size = info->stacksize;
5035 m->p_size_valid = 1;
5036 }
5037
5038 *pm = m;
5039 pm = &m->next;
5040 }
5041
5042 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
5043 {
5044 for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
5045 {
5046 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
5047 && m->count != 0
5048 && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
5049 && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
5050 {
5051 i = m->count;
5052 while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
5053 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5054 == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5055 break;
5056
5057 if (i != (unsigned) -1)
5058 break;
5059 }
5060 }
5061
5062 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5063 if (m != NULL)
5064 {
5065 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5066 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5067 if (m == NULL)
5068 goto error_return;
5069 m->next = NULL;
5070 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
5071 *pm = m;
5072 pm = &m->next;
5073 }
5074 }
5075
5076 free (sections);
5077 elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
5078 }
5079
5080 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
5081 return FALSE;
5082
5083 for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5084 ++count;
5085 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5086
5087 return TRUE;
5088
5089 error_return:
5090 if (sections != NULL)
5091 free (sections);
5092 return FALSE;
5093 }
5094
5095 /* Sort sections by address. */
5096
5097 static int
5098 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5099 {
5100 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
5101 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
5102 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
5103
5104 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5105 place the section into a segment. */
5106 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
5107 return -1;
5108 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
5109 return 1;
5110
5111 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5112 the same, and this will do nothing. */
5113 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
5114 return -1;
5115 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
5116 return 1;
5117
5118 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5119
5120 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
5121
5122 if (TOEND (sec1))
5123 {
5124 if (TOEND (sec2))
5125 {
5126 /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
5127 here, but continue to try the next comparison. */
5128 if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
5129 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5130 }
5131 else
5132 return 1;
5133 }
5134 else if (TOEND (sec2))
5135 return -1;
5136
5137 #undef TOEND
5138
5139 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5140 before others at the same address. */
5141
5142 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
5143 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
5144
5145 if (size1 < size2)
5146 return -1;
5147 if (size1 > size2)
5148 return 1;
5149
5150 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5151 }
5152
5153 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5154
5155 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5156 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5157 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5158 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5159 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5160 which is wrong.
5161
5162 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5163 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5164 the page size.'' */
5165 /* In other words, something like:
5166
5167 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5168 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5169 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5170 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5171 else
5172 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5173
5174 which can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5175
5176 static file_ptr
5177 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
5178 {
5179 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5180 if (maxpagesize == 0)
5181 maxpagesize = 1;
5182 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
5183 }
5184
5185 static void
5186 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
5187 {
5188 unsigned int j;
5189 const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
5190 char buf[32];
5191
5192 if (pt == NULL)
5193 {
5194 if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
5195 sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5196 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
5197 else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
5198 sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5199 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
5200 else
5201 snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
5202 (unsigned int) m->p_type);
5203 pt = buf;
5204 }
5205 fflush (stdout);
5206 fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
5207 for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
5208 fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
5209 putc ('\n',stderr);
5210 fflush (stderr);
5211 }
5212
5213 static bfd_boolean
5214 write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
5215 {
5216 void *buf;
5217 bfd_boolean ret;
5218
5219 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
5220 return FALSE;
5221 buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
5222 if (buf == NULL)
5223 return FALSE;
5224 ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
5225 free (buf);
5226 return ret;
5227 }
5228
5229 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5230 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5231 the file header. */
5232
5233 static bfd_boolean
5234 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5235 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5236 {
5237 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5238 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5239 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5240 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5241 file_ptr off;
5242 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
5243 unsigned int pt_load_count = 0;
5244 unsigned int alloc;
5245 unsigned int i, j;
5246 bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
5247
5248 if (link_info == NULL
5249 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
5250 return FALSE;
5251
5252 alloc = 0;
5253 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5254 {
5255 ++alloc;
5256 if (m->header_size)
5257 header_pad = m->header_size;
5258 }
5259
5260 if (alloc)
5261 {
5262 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5263 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5264 }
5265 else
5266 {
5267 /* PR binutils/12467. */
5268 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
5269 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
5270 }
5271
5272 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
5273
5274 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
5275 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5276 else
5277 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
5278 >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
5279
5280 if (alloc == 0)
5281 {
5282 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5283 return TRUE;
5284 }
5285
5286 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5287 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5288 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5289 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5290 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5291 layout.
5292 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5293 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5294 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5295 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd) % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
5296 == 0);
5297 phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
5298 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd,
5299 (elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
5300 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
5301 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
5302 if (phdrs == NULL)
5303 return FALSE;
5304
5305 maxpagesize = 1;
5306 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5307 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
5308
5309 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5310 off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5311 if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
5312 header_pad = 0;
5313 else
5314 header_pad -= off;
5315 off += header_pad;
5316
5317 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs, j = 0;
5318 m != NULL;
5319 m = m->next, p++, j++)
5320 {
5321 asection **secpp;
5322 bfd_vma off_adjust;
5323 bfd_boolean no_contents;
5324
5325 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5326 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5327 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5328 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5329 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5330 if (m->count > 1
5331 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
5332 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
5333 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
5334 elf_sort_sections);
5335
5336 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5337 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5338 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5339 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5340 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5341 p->p_type = m->p_type;
5342 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
5343
5344 if (m->count == 0)
5345 p->p_vaddr = 0;
5346 else
5347 p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5348
5349 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
5350 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
5351 else if (m->count == 0)
5352 p->p_paddr = 0;
5353 else
5354 p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5355
5356 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5357 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5358 {
5359 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5360 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5361 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5362 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5363 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5364 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5365 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5366 segment. */
5367 if (m->p_align_valid)
5368 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
5369
5370 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
5371 pt_load_count += 1;
5372 }
5373 else if (m->p_align_valid)
5374 p->p_align = m->p_align;
5375 else if (m->count == 0)
5376 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
5377 else
5378 p->p_align = 0;
5379
5380 no_contents = FALSE;
5381 off_adjust = 0;
5382 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5383 && m->count > 0)
5384 {
5385 bfd_size_type align;
5386 unsigned int align_power = 0;
5387
5388 if (m->p_align_valid)
5389 align = p->p_align;
5390 else
5391 {
5392 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5393 {
5394 unsigned int secalign;
5395
5396 secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
5397 if (secalign > align_power)
5398 align_power = secalign;
5399 }
5400 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
5401 if (align < maxpagesize)
5402 align = maxpagesize;
5403 }
5404
5405 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5406 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
5407 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5408 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5409 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5410 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
5411
5412 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5413 sections. */
5414 no_contents = TRUE;
5415 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5416 if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
5417 {
5418 no_contents = FALSE;
5419 break;
5420 }
5421
5422 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
5423
5424 /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5425 map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5426 processors. */
5427 if (pt_load_count > 1
5428 && bed->no_page_alias
5429 && (off & (maxpagesize - 1)) != 0
5430 && (off & -maxpagesize) == ((off + off_adjust) & -maxpagesize))
5431 off_adjust += maxpagesize;
5432 off += off_adjust;
5433 if (no_contents)
5434 {
5435 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5436 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5437 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5438 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5439 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5440 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5441 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5442 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5443 }
5444 else
5445 off_adjust = 0;
5446 }
5447 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5448 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5449 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
5450 && m->count > 1
5451 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
5452 {
5453 _bfd_error_handler
5454 (_("%pB: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
5455 " is not the .dynamic section"),
5456 abfd);
5457 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5458 return FALSE;
5459 }
5460 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5461 else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
5462 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5463 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
5464
5465 p->p_offset = 0;
5466 p->p_filesz = 0;
5467 p->p_memsz = 0;
5468
5469 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5470 {
5471 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5472 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5473 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5474 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5475 if (m->count > 0)
5476 {
5477 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off
5478 || (!m->p_paddr_valid
5479 && p->p_paddr < (bfd_vma) off))
5480 {
5481 _bfd_error_handler
5482 (_("%pB: not enough room for program headers,"
5483 " try linking with -N"),
5484 abfd);
5485 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5486 return FALSE;
5487 }
5488
5489 p->p_vaddr -= off;
5490 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5491 p->p_paddr -= off;
5492 }
5493 }
5494
5495 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5496 {
5497 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5498 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5499
5500 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5501 {
5502 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5503
5504 if (m->count > 0)
5505 {
5506 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5507 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5508 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5509 }
5510 }
5511
5512 p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5513 p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5514 if (m->count)
5515 {
5516 p->p_filesz += header_pad;
5517 p->p_memsz += header_pad;
5518 }
5519 }
5520
5521 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5522 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5523 {
5524 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5525 p->p_offset = off;
5526 else
5527 {
5528 file_ptr adjust;
5529
5530 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5531 if (!no_contents)
5532 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5533 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5534 }
5535 }
5536
5537 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5538 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5539 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5540 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5541 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5542 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5543 {
5544 asection *sec;
5545 bfd_size_type align;
5546 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5547
5548 sec = *secpp;
5549 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5550 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
5551
5552 if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5553 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5554 && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5555 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5556 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5557 || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5558 {
5559 bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
5560 bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
5561 bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
5562 bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
5563
5564 if (adjust != 0
5565 && (s_start < p_end
5566 || p_end < p_start))
5567 {
5568 _bfd_error_handler
5569 /* xgettext:c-format */
5570 (_("%pB: section %pA lma %#" PRIx64 " adjusted to %#" PRIx64),
5571 abfd, sec, (uint64_t) s_start, (uint64_t) p_end);
5572 adjust = 0;
5573 sec->lma = p_end;
5574 }
5575 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5576
5577 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5578 {
5579 if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5580 {
5581 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5582 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5583 zero it. */
5584 adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5585 if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5586 return FALSE;
5587 }
5588 off += adjust;
5589 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5590 }
5591 }
5592
5593 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5594 {
5595 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5596 everything. */
5597 if (i == 0)
5598 {
5599 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5600 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5601 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5602 p->p_memsz = 0;
5603 p->p_align = 1;
5604 }
5605 else
5606 {
5607 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5608 sec->filepos = 0;
5609 sec->size = 0;
5610 sec->flags = 0;
5611 continue;
5612 }
5613 }
5614 else
5615 {
5616 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5617 {
5618 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5619 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5620 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5621 }
5622 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5623 && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5624 && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5625 {
5626 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5627 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5628 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5629 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5630 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5631 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5632 p_offset value. */
5633 bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5634 off, align);
5635 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5636 }
5637
5638 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5639 {
5640 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5641 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5642 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5643 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5644 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5645 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5646 }
5647 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5648 {
5649 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5650 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5651
5652 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5653 normal segments. */
5654 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5655 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5656 }
5657
5658 if (align > p->p_align
5659 && !m->p_align_valid
5660 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5661 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5662 p->p_align = align;
5663 }
5664
5665 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5666 {
5667 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5668 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5669 p->p_flags |= PF_X;
5670 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5671 p->p_flags |= PF_W;
5672 }
5673 }
5674
5675 off -= off_adjust;
5676
5677 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5678 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5679 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5680 {
5681 bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
5682
5683 for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5684 if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5685 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5686 ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5687 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5688 ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5689 {
5690 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5691 check_vma = FALSE;
5692 break;
5693 }
5694
5695 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5696 {
5697 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5698 asection *sec;
5699
5700 sec = m->sections[i];
5701 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
5702 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
5703 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
5704 {
5705 _bfd_error_handler
5706 /* xgettext:c-format */
5707 (_("%pB: section `%pA' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5708 abfd, sec, j);
5709 print_segment_map (m);
5710 }
5711 }
5712 }
5713 }
5714
5715 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5716 return TRUE;
5717 }
5718
5719 /* Assign file positions for the other sections. */
5720
5721 static bfd_boolean
5722 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5723 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5724 {
5725 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5726 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
5727 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
5728 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5729 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5730 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5731 struct elf_segment_map *hdrs_segment;
5732 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
5733 bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
5734 file_ptr off;
5735 unsigned int count;
5736
5737 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5738 end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
5739 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5740 for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
5741 {
5742 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5743
5744 hdr = *hdrpp;
5745 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5746 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
5747 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5748 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
5749 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
5750 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5751 {
5752 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
5753 _bfd_error_handler
5754 /* xgettext:c-format */
5755 (_("%pB: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
5756 abfd,
5757 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
5758 ? "*unknown*"
5759 : hdr->bfd_section->name));
5760 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
5761 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
5762 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5763 bed->maxpagesize);
5764 else
5765 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5766 hdr->sh_addralign);
5767 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
5768 FALSE);
5769 }
5770 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5771 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5772 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5773 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
5774 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5775 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
5776 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
5777 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
5778 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
5779 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
5780 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5781 else
5782 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5783 }
5784
5785 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
5786 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
5787 count = 0;
5788 filehdr_vaddr = 0;
5789 filehdr_paddr = 0;
5790 phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5791 phdrs_paddr = 0;
5792 hdrs_segment = NULL;
5793 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
5794 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5795 {
5796 ++count;
5797 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5798 continue;
5799
5800 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5801 {
5802 filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5803 filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5804 }
5805 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5806 {
5807 phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5808 phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5809 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5810 {
5811 hdrs_segment = m;
5812 phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5813 phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5814 }
5815 }
5816 }
5817
5818 if (hdrs_segment != NULL && link_info != NULL)
5819 {
5820 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
5821 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
5822 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
5823
5824 struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
5825 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
5826 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
5827 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
5828 if (hash != NULL
5829 && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
5830 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5831 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5832 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
5833 {
5834 asection *s = NULL;
5835 if (hdrs_segment->count != 0)
5836 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
5837 s = hdrs_segment->sections[0];
5838 else
5839 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
5840 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5841 if (m->count != 0)
5842 {
5843 s = m->sections[0];
5844 break;
5845 }
5846
5847 if (s != NULL)
5848 {
5849 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
5850 hash->root.u.def.section = s;
5851 }
5852 else
5853 {
5854 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
5855 hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
5856 }
5857
5858 hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5859 hash->def_regular = 1;
5860 hash->non_elf = 0;
5861 }
5862 }
5863
5864 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5865 {
5866 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
5867 {
5868 bfd_vma start, end;
5869 bfd_boolean ok;
5870
5871 if (link_info != NULL)
5872 {
5873 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
5874 in link_info. Note that there may be padding between
5875 relro_start and the first RELRO section. */
5876 start = link_info->relro_start;
5877 end = link_info->relro_end;
5878 }
5879 else if (m->count != 0)
5880 {
5881 if (!m->p_size_valid)
5882 abort ();
5883 start = m->sections[0]->vma;
5884 end = start + m->p_size;
5885 }
5886 else
5887 {
5888 start = 0;
5889 end = 0;
5890 }
5891
5892 ok = FALSE;
5893 if (start < end)
5894 {
5895 struct elf_segment_map *lm;
5896 const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
5897 unsigned int i;
5898
5899 /* Find a LOAD segment containing a section in the RELRO
5900 segment. */
5901 for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
5902 lm != NULL;
5903 lm = lm->next, lp++)
5904 {
5905 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5906 && lm->count != 0
5907 && (lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->vma
5908 + (!IS_TBSS (lm->sections[lm->count - 1])
5909 ? lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->size
5910 : 0)) > start
5911 && lm->sections[0]->vma < end)
5912 break;
5913 }
5914
5915 if (lm != NULL)
5916 {
5917 /* Find the section starting the RELRO segment. */
5918 for (i = 0; i < lm->count; i++)
5919 {
5920 asection *s = lm->sections[i];
5921 if (s->vma >= start
5922 && s->vma < end
5923 && s->size != 0)
5924 break;
5925 }
5926
5927 if (i < lm->count)
5928 {
5929 p->p_vaddr = lm->sections[i]->vma;
5930 p->p_paddr = lm->sections[i]->lma;
5931 p->p_offset = lm->sections[i]->filepos;
5932 p->p_memsz = end - p->p_vaddr;
5933 p->p_filesz = p->p_memsz;
5934
5935 /* The RELRO segment typically ends a few bytes
5936 into .got.plt but other layouts are possible.
5937 In cases where the end does not match any
5938 loaded section (for instance is in file
5939 padding), trim p_filesz back to correspond to
5940 the end of loaded section contents. */
5941 if (p->p_filesz > lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr)
5942 p->p_filesz = lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr;
5943
5944 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are
5945 valid. The gold linker generates RW/4 for
5946 the PT_GNU_RELRO section. It is better for
5947 objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
5948 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate
5949 debug files. */
5950 if (!m->p_align_valid)
5951 p->p_align = 1;
5952 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5953 p->p_flags = PF_R;
5954 ok = TRUE;
5955 }
5956 }
5957 }
5958 if (link_info != NULL)
5959 BFD_ASSERT (ok);
5960 if (!ok)
5961 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
5962 }
5963 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
5964 {
5965 if (m->p_size_valid)
5966 p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
5967 }
5968 else if (m->count != 0)
5969 {
5970 unsigned int i;
5971
5972 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5973 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
5974 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
5975 {
5976 /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
5977 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
5978 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR)
5979 {
5980 m->count = 0;
5981 continue;
5982 }
5983
5984 if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
5985 {
5986 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
5987 _bfd_error_handler
5988 (_("%pB: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
5989 "and/or program header"),
5990 abfd, (int) (p - phdrs));
5991 return FALSE;
5992 }
5993
5994 p->p_filesz = 0;
5995 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
5996 for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
5997 {
5998 asection *sect = m->sections[i];
5999 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
6000 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
6001 {
6002 p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
6003 + hdr->sh_size);
6004 break;
6005 }
6006 }
6007 }
6008 }
6009 else if (m->includes_filehdr)
6010 {
6011 p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
6012 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
6013 p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
6014 }
6015 else if (m->includes_phdrs)
6016 {
6017 p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
6018 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
6019 p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
6020 }
6021 }
6022
6023 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6024
6025 return TRUE;
6026 }
6027
6028 static elf_section_list *
6029 find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
6030 {
6031 for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
6032 if (list->ndx == i)
6033 break;
6034 return list;
6035 }
6036
6037 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
6038 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
6039 VMAs must be known before this is called.
6040
6041 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
6042 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
6043 those that bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are
6044 stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't
6045 consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
6046 image. Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
6047 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
6048
6049 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
6050
6051 static bfd_boolean
6052 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
6053 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6054 {
6055 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
6056 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6057 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6058
6059 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
6060 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
6061 {
6062 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6063 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6064 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
6065 unsigned int i;
6066 file_ptr off;
6067
6068 /* Start after the ELF header. */
6069 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
6070
6071 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
6072 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
6073 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
6074 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
6075 {
6076 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6077
6078 hdr = *hdrpp;
6079 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6080 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6081 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6082 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
6083 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6084 || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
6085 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6086 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6087 || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
6088 || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
6089 {
6090 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6091 }
6092 else
6093 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
6094 }
6095
6096 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6097 }
6098 else
6099 {
6100 unsigned int alloc;
6101
6102 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6103 assignment of sections to segments. */
6104 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6105 return FALSE;
6106
6107 /* And for non-load sections. */
6108 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6109 return FALSE;
6110
6111 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
6112 {
6113 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
6114 return FALSE;
6115 }
6116
6117 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=. */
6118 if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
6119 {
6120 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
6121 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
6122 Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
6123
6124 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6125 bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
6126 for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
6127 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
6128 p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6129
6130 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6131 segments is non-zero. */
6132 if (p_vaddr)
6133 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6134 }
6135
6136 /* Write out the program headers. */
6137 alloc = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
6138 if (alloc == 0)
6139 return TRUE;
6140
6141 /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if present, will
6142 be loaded into memory. FIXME: The check below is not sufficient as
6143 really all PT_LOAD segments should be checked before issuing an error
6144 message. Plus the PHDR segment does not have to be the first segment
6145 in the program header table. But this version of the check should
6146 catch all real world use cases.
6147
6148 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6149 ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6150 including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6151 changed or the programs updated. */
6152 if (alloc > 1
6153 && tdata->phdr[0].p_type == PT_PHDR
6154 && (bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr == NULL
6155 || !bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd, tdata->phdr,
6156 alloc))
6157 && tdata->phdr[1].p_type == PT_LOAD
6158 && (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr > tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr
6159 || (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[1].p_memsz
6160 < tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[0].p_memsz)))
6161 {
6162 /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
6163 used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
6164 leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
6165 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: error: PHDR segment not covered"
6166 " by LOAD segment"),
6167 abfd);
6168 return FALSE;
6169 }
6170
6171 if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
6172 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
6173 return FALSE;
6174 }
6175
6176 return TRUE;
6177 }
6178
6179 static bfd_boolean
6180 prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
6181 {
6182 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6183 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
6184 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6185
6186 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6187
6188 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6189 if (shstrtab == NULL)
6190 return FALSE;
6191
6192 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
6193
6194 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
6195 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
6196 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
6197 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
6198
6199 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
6200 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
6201 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
6202 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
6203
6204 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6205 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
6206 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
6207 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6208 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
6209 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
6210 else
6211 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
6212
6213 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
6214 {
6215 case bfd_arch_unknown:
6216 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
6217 break;
6218
6219 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6220 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6221 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6222 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6223 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6224 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6225 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6226 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6227 default:
6228 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
6229 }
6230
6231 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
6232 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
6233
6234 /* No program header, for now. */
6235 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6236 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6237 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
6238
6239 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6240 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
6241 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
6242
6243 /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table. */
6244 if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
6245 /* It all happens later. */
6246 ;
6247 else
6248 {
6249 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6250 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6251 }
6252
6253 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
6254 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
6255 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
6256 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
6257 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
6258 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
6259 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6260 || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6261 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
6262 return FALSE;
6263
6264 return TRUE;
6265 }
6266
6267 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6268 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6269
6270 static bfd_boolean
6271 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
6272 {
6273 file_ptr off;
6274 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
6275 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
6276 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
6277 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6278
6279 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6280
6281 shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6282 end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6283 for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
6284 {
6285 shdrp = *shdrpp;
6286 if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
6287 {
6288 asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
6289 bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
6290 || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
6291 if (is_rel
6292 || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
6293 {
6294 if (!is_rel)
6295 {
6296 const char *name = sec->name;
6297 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
6298
6299 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6300 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
6301 shdrp->contents))
6302 return FALSE;
6303
6304 if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6305 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
6306 {
6307 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6308 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6309 char *new_name
6310 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
6311 if (new_name == NULL)
6312 return FALSE;
6313 name = new_name;
6314 }
6315 /* Add section name to section name section. */
6316 if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
6317 abort ();
6318 shdrp->sh_name
6319 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6320 name, FALSE);
6321 d = elf_section_data (sec);
6322
6323 /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6324 if (d->rel.hdr
6325 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6326 d->rel.hdr,
6327 name, FALSE))
6328 return FALSE;
6329 if (d->rela.hdr
6330 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6331 d->rela.hdr,
6332 name, TRUE))
6333 return FALSE;
6334
6335 /* Update section size and contents. */
6336 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6337 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6338 shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
6339 }
6340 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
6341 off,
6342 TRUE);
6343 }
6344 }
6345 }
6346
6347 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6348 compressed. */
6349 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6350 shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
6351 shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6352 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
6353
6354 /* Place the section headers. */
6355 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6356 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6357 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
6358 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
6359 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
6360 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6361
6362 return TRUE;
6363 }
6364
6365 bfd_boolean
6366 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
6367 {
6368 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6369 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
6370 bfd_boolean failed;
6371 unsigned int count, num_sec;
6372 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
6373
6374 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
6375 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
6376 return FALSE;
6377
6378 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6379
6380 failed = FALSE;
6381 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
6382 if (failed)
6383 return FALSE;
6384
6385 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
6386 return FALSE;
6387
6388 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6389 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6390 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
6391 {
6392 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
6393 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6394 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
6395 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
6396 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]))
6397 return FALSE;
6398 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
6399 {
6400 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
6401
6402 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6403 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
6404 return FALSE;
6405 }
6406 }
6407
6408 /* Write out the section header names. */
6409 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
6410 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
6411 && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6412 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
6413 return FALSE;
6414
6415 if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
6416 (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd, elf_linker (abfd));
6417
6418 if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
6419 return FALSE;
6420
6421 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6422 if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
6423 return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
6424
6425 return TRUE;
6426 }
6427
6428 bfd_boolean
6429 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
6430 {
6431 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6432 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
6433 }
6434
6435 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6436
6437 unsigned int
6438 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
6439 {
6440 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6441 unsigned int sec_index;
6442
6443 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
6444 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
6445 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
6446
6447 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
6448 sec_index = SHN_ABS;
6449 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
6450 sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
6451 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
6452 sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
6453 else
6454 sec_index = SHN_BAD;
6455
6456 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6457 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
6458 {
6459 int retval = sec_index;
6460
6461 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
6462 return retval;
6463 }
6464
6465 if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
6466 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
6467
6468 return sec_index;
6469 }
6470
6471 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6472 on error. */
6473
6474 int
6475 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
6476 {
6477 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
6478 int idx;
6479 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
6480
6481 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6482 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6483 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6484 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6485 input sections rather than the output section. */
6486 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
6487 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6488 && asym_ptr->section)
6489 {
6490 asection *sec;
6491 int indx;
6492
6493 sec = asym_ptr->section;
6494 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
6495 sec = sec->output_section;
6496 if (sec->owner == abfd
6497 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
6498 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
6499 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
6500 }
6501
6502 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
6503
6504 if (idx == 0)
6505 {
6506 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6507 which is used in a relocation entry. */
6508 _bfd_error_handler
6509 /* xgettext:c-format */
6510 (_("%pB: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6511 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
6512 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
6513 return -1;
6514 }
6515
6516 #if DEBUG & 4
6517 {
6518 fprintf (stderr,
6519 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
6520 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, flags);
6521 fflush (stderr);
6522 }
6523 #endif
6524
6525 return idx;
6526 }
6527
6528 /* Rewrite program header information. */
6529
6530 static bfd_boolean
6531 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6532 {
6533 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6534 struct elf_segment_map *map;
6535 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6536 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6537 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6538 asection *section;
6539 unsigned int i;
6540 unsigned int num_segments;
6541 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6542 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6543 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
6544 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
6545 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
6546 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6547
6548 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6549 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6550
6551 map_first = NULL;
6552 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6553
6554 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6555 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
6556
6557 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6558 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6559 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6560 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6561
6562 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6563 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6564 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6565 ? section->size : 0)
6566
6567 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6568 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6569 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
6570 (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
6571 && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6572 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6573
6574 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6575 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6576 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
6577 (section->lma >= base \
6578 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6579 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6580
6581 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6582 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6583 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6584 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6585 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6586 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6587 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6588
6589 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6590 etc. */
6591 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6592 (IS_NOTE (p, s) \
6593 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6594 && s->vma == 0 \
6595 && s->lma == 0)
6596
6597 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6598 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6599 p_memsz set to 0. */
6600 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6601 (p->p_vaddr == 0 \
6602 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6603 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6604 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6605 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6606 && s->size > 0 \
6607 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6608 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6609 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6610
6611 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6612 A section will be included if:
6613 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6614 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6615 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6616 segment.
6617 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6618 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6619 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6620 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6621 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6622 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6623 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6624 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6625 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6626 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
6627 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
6628 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6629 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6630 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6631 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6632 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6633 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6634 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6635 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6636 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6637 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6638 || (segment->p_paddr \
6639 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
6640 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
6641 || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic") \
6642 == 0)) \
6643 && !section->segment_mark)
6644
6645 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6646 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6647 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6648 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
6649 && section->output_section != NULL)
6650
6651 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6652 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6653 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6654
6655 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6656 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6657 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6658 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6659 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6660 LMA. */
6661 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6662 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6663 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6664 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6665 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6666
6667 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6668 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6669 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6670
6671 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6672 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6673 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6674 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6675 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6676 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6677 i < num_segments;
6678 i++, segment++)
6679 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6680 {
6681 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6682 break;
6683 }
6684
6685 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6686 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6687 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6688 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6689 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6690 i < num_segments;
6691 i++, segment++)
6692 {
6693 unsigned int j;
6694 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6695
6696 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6697 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6698 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6699 {
6700 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6701 assignment code will work. */
6702 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
6703 break;
6704 }
6705
6706 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6707 {
6708 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6709 if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6710 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6711 continue;
6712 }
6713
6714 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
6715 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
6716 {
6717 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
6718
6719 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
6720 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
6721 continue;
6722
6723 /* Merge the two segments together. */
6724 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
6725 {
6726 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
6727 SEGMENT. */
6728 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
6729 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
6730
6731 if (extra_length > 0)
6732 {
6733 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
6734 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
6735 }
6736
6737 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6738
6739 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
6740 i = 0;
6741 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6742 break;
6743 }
6744 else
6745 {
6746 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
6747 SEGMENT2. */
6748 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
6749 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
6750
6751 if (extra_length > 0)
6752 {
6753 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
6754 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
6755 }
6756
6757 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
6758 }
6759 }
6760 }
6761
6762 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
6763 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6764 i < num_segments;
6765 i++, segment++)
6766 {
6767 unsigned int section_count;
6768 asection **sections;
6769 asection *output_section;
6770 unsigned int isec;
6771 bfd_vma matching_lma;
6772 bfd_vma suggested_lma;
6773 unsigned int j;
6774 bfd_size_type amt;
6775 asection *first_section;
6776 bfd_boolean first_matching_lma;
6777 bfd_boolean first_suggested_lma;
6778
6779 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
6780 continue;
6781
6782 first_section = NULL;
6783 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
6784 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6785 section != NULL;
6786 section = section->next)
6787 {
6788 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
6789 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6790 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6791 {
6792 if (first_section == NULL)
6793 first_section = section;
6794 if (section->output_section != NULL)
6795 ++section_count;
6796 }
6797 }
6798
6799 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6800 all of the sections we have selected. */
6801 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6802 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6803 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6804 if (map == NULL)
6805 return FALSE;
6806
6807 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
6808 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
6809 map->next = NULL;
6810 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6811 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6812 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6813
6814 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
6815 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
6816 output segment. */
6817 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
6818 {
6819 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6820 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6821 }
6822
6823 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6824 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6825 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6826 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6827 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6828
6829 if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6830 {
6831 map->includes_phdrs =
6832 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6833 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6834 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6835 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6836
6837 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6838 phdr_included = TRUE;
6839 }
6840
6841 if (section_count == 0)
6842 {
6843 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
6844 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
6845 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
6846 a warning is produced.
6847 There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
6848 have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
6849 flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
6850 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
6851 && (segment->p_filesz > 0 || segment->p_memsz == 0))
6852 /* xgettext:c-format */
6853 _bfd_error_handler
6854 (_("%pB: warning: empty loadable segment detected"
6855 " at vaddr=%#" PRIx64 ", is this intentional?"),
6856 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_vaddr);
6857
6858 map->count = 0;
6859 *pointer_to_map = map;
6860 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6861
6862 continue;
6863 }
6864
6865 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
6866 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
6867 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
6868 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
6869
6870 1. None of the sections have been moved.
6871 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
6872 input BFD.
6873
6874 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
6875 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6876 of the first section.
6877
6878 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
6879 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
6880 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
6881 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
6882 have to be created to contain the other sections.
6883
6884 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
6885 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6886 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
6887 or segments to contain the other sections.
6888
6889 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
6890 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
6891 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
6892
6893 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
6894 if (sections == NULL)
6895 return FALSE;
6896
6897 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
6898 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
6899 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
6900 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
6901 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
6902 more to do. */
6903 isec = 0;
6904 matching_lma = 0;
6905 suggested_lma = 0;
6906 first_matching_lma = TRUE;
6907 first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
6908
6909 for (section = first_section, j = 0;
6910 section != NULL;
6911 section = section->next)
6912 {
6913 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6914 {
6915 output_section = section->output_section;
6916
6917 sections[j++] = section;
6918
6919 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
6920 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
6921 correct value. Note - some backends require that
6922 p_paddr be left as zero. */
6923 if (!p_paddr_valid
6924 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
6925 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6926 && isec == 0
6927 && output_section->lma != 0
6928 && output_section->vma == (segment->p_vaddr
6929 + (map->includes_filehdr
6930 ? iehdr->e_ehsize
6931 : 0)
6932 + (map->includes_phdrs
6933 ? (iehdr->e_phnum
6934 * iehdr->e_phentsize)
6935 : 0)))
6936 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6937
6938 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
6939 LMA address of the output section. */
6940 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6941 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
6942 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6943 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
6944 {
6945 if (first_matching_lma || output_section->lma < matching_lma)
6946 {
6947 matching_lma = output_section->lma;
6948 first_matching_lma = FALSE;
6949 }
6950
6951 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
6952 then it does not overlap any other section within that
6953 segment. */
6954 map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
6955 }
6956 else if (first_suggested_lma)
6957 {
6958 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
6959 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
6960 }
6961
6962 if (j == section_count)
6963 break;
6964 }
6965 }
6966
6967 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
6968
6969 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
6970 if necessary. */
6971 if (isec == section_count)
6972 {
6973 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
6974 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
6975 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
6976 program header in the input BFD. */
6977 map->count = section_count;
6978 *pointer_to_map = map;
6979 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6980
6981 if (p_paddr_valid
6982 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6983 && matching_lma != map->p_paddr
6984 && !map->includes_filehdr
6985 && !map->includes_phdrs)
6986 /* There is some padding before the first section in the
6987 segment. So, we must account for that in the output
6988 segment's vma. */
6989 map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma - map->p_paddr;
6990
6991 free (sections);
6992 continue;
6993 }
6994 else
6995 {
6996 if (!first_matching_lma)
6997 {
6998 /* At least one section fits inside the current segment.
6999 Keep it, but modify its physical address to match the
7000 LMA of the first section that fitted. */
7001 map->p_paddr = matching_lma;
7002 }
7003 else
7004 {
7005 /* None of the sections fitted inside the current segment.
7006 Change the current segment's physical address to match
7007 the LMA of the first section. */
7008 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
7009 }
7010
7011 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
7012 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
7013 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7014 {
7015 if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_ehsize)
7016 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
7017 else
7018 {
7019 map->includes_filehdr = FALSE;
7020 map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
7021 }
7022 }
7023
7024 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7025 {
7026 if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)
7027 {
7028 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7029
7030 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
7031 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
7032 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
7033 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
7034 offset when we know the correct value. */
7035 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
7036 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
7037 }
7038 else
7039 map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
7040 }
7041 }
7042
7043 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
7044 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
7045 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
7046 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
7047 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
7048 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
7049 the loop. */
7050 isec = 0;
7051 do
7052 {
7053 map->count = 0;
7054 suggested_lma = 0;
7055 first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
7056
7057 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
7058 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
7059 {
7060 section = sections[j];
7061
7062 if (section == NULL)
7063 continue;
7064
7065 output_section = section->output_section;
7066
7067 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
7068
7069 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
7070 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
7071 {
7072 if (map->count == 0)
7073 {
7074 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
7075 the beginning of the segment, then something is
7076 wrong. */
7077 if (output_section->lma
7078 != (map->p_paddr
7079 + (map->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7080 + (map->includes_phdrs
7081 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7082 : 0)))
7083 abort ();
7084 }
7085 else
7086 {
7087 asection *prev_sec;
7088
7089 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
7090
7091 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
7092 and the start of this section is more than
7093 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
7094 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
7095 maxpagesize)
7096 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
7097 || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
7098 > output_section->lma))
7099 {
7100 if (first_suggested_lma)
7101 {
7102 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
7103 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
7104 }
7105
7106 continue;
7107 }
7108 }
7109
7110 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
7111 ++isec;
7112 sections[j] = NULL;
7113 section->segment_mark = TRUE;
7114 }
7115 else if (first_suggested_lma)
7116 {
7117 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
7118 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
7119 }
7120 }
7121
7122 BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
7123
7124 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7125 *pointer_to_map = map;
7126 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7127
7128 if (isec < section_count)
7129 {
7130 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7131 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7132 and carry on looping. */
7133 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7134 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7135 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7136 if (map == NULL)
7137 {
7138 free (sections);
7139 return FALSE;
7140 }
7141
7142 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7143 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7144 not yet been assigned. */
7145 map->next = NULL;
7146 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7147 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7148 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7149 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
7150 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7151 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
7152 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7153 }
7154 }
7155 while (isec < section_count);
7156
7157 free (sections);
7158 }
7159
7160 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7161
7162 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7163 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7164 the offset if necessary. */
7165 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
7166 {
7167 unsigned int count;
7168
7169 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7170 count++;
7171
7172 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
7173 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
7174 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7175 }
7176
7177 #undef SEGMENT_END
7178 #undef SECTION_SIZE
7179 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7180 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7181 #undef IS_NOTE
7182 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7183 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7184 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7185 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7186 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7187 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7188 return TRUE;
7189 }
7190
7191 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
7192
7193 static bfd_boolean
7194 copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7195 {
7196 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
7197 struct elf_segment_map *map;
7198 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
7199 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
7200 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7201 unsigned int i;
7202 unsigned int num_segments;
7203 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
7204 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
7205
7206 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
7207
7208 map_first = NULL;
7209 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
7210
7211 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7212 map->p_paddr_valid. */
7213 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7214 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7215 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7216 i < num_segments;
7217 i++, segment++)
7218 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
7219 {
7220 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
7221 break;
7222 }
7223
7224 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7225 i < num_segments;
7226 i++, segment++)
7227 {
7228 asection *section;
7229 unsigned int section_count;
7230 bfd_size_type amt;
7231 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7232 asection *first_section = NULL;
7233 asection *lowest_section;
7234
7235 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7236 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7237 section != NULL;
7238 section = section->next)
7239 {
7240 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7241 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7242 {
7243 if (first_section == NULL)
7244 first_section = section;
7245 section_count++;
7246 }
7247 }
7248
7249 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7250 all of the sections we have selected. */
7251 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7252 if (section_count != 0)
7253 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7254 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7255 if (map == NULL)
7256 return FALSE;
7257
7258 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7259 input segment. */
7260 map->next = NULL;
7261 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7262 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7263 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7264 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7265 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7266 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7267 map->p_align_valid = 1;
7268 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
7269
7270 if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
7271 || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
7272 {
7273 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7274 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7275 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7276 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7277 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7278 systems. */
7279 map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
7280 map->p_size_valid = 1;
7281 }
7282
7283 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7284 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7285 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7286 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7287
7288 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7289 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7290 {
7291 map->includes_phdrs =
7292 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7293 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7294 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7295 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7296
7297 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7298 phdr_included = TRUE;
7299 }
7300
7301 lowest_section = NULL;
7302 if (section_count != 0)
7303 {
7304 unsigned int isec = 0;
7305
7306 for (section = first_section;
7307 section != NULL;
7308 section = section->next)
7309 {
7310 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7311 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7312 {
7313 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
7314 if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7315 {
7316 bfd_vma seg_off;
7317
7318 if (lowest_section == NULL
7319 || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
7320 lowest_section = section;
7321
7322 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7323 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7324 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7325 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7326 invalid. */
7327 if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7328 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
7329 else
7330 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
7331 if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
7332 map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7333 }
7334 if (isec == section_count)
7335 break;
7336 }
7337 }
7338 }
7339
7340 if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
7341 /* We need to keep the space used by the headers fixed. */
7342 map->header_size = lowest_section->vma - segment->p_vaddr;
7343
7344 if (!map->includes_phdrs
7345 && !map->includes_filehdr
7346 && map->p_paddr_valid)
7347 /* There is some other padding before the first section. */
7348 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
7349 - segment->p_paddr);
7350
7351 map->count = section_count;
7352 *pointer_to_map = map;
7353 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7354 }
7355
7356 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7357 return TRUE;
7358 }
7359
7360 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7361 information. */
7362
7363 static bfd_boolean
7364 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7365 {
7366 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7367 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7368 return TRUE;
7369
7370 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
7371 return TRUE;
7372
7373 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7374 {
7375 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7376 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7377 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7378 asection *section, *osec;
7379 unsigned int i, num_segments;
7380 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7381 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7382
7383 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
7384
7385 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7386 if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7387 goto rewrite;
7388
7389 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7390 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7391 section = section->next)
7392 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7393
7394 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7395 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7396 i < num_segments;
7397 i++, segment++)
7398 {
7399 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7400 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7401 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7402 map in this case. */
7403 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
7404 && segment->p_memsz == 0
7405 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
7406 goto rewrite;
7407
7408 for (section = ibfd->sections;
7409 section != NULL; section = section->next)
7410 {
7411 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7412 from the input BFD. */
7413 osec = section->output_section;
7414 if (osec)
7415 osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
7416
7417 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7418 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7419 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7420 {
7421 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7422 removed. What else do we need to check? */
7423 if (osec == NULL
7424 || section->flags != osec->flags
7425 || section->lma != osec->lma
7426 || section->vma != osec->vma
7427 || section->size != osec->size
7428 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
7429 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
7430 goto rewrite;
7431 }
7432 }
7433 }
7434
7435 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7436 input BFD. */
7437 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7438 section = section->next)
7439 {
7440 if (!section->segment_mark)
7441 goto rewrite;
7442 else
7443 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7444 }
7445
7446 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7447 }
7448
7449 rewrite:
7450 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7451 {
7452 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7453 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7454 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7455 unsigned int i;
7456 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7457 bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
7458
7459 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7460 i < num_segments;
7461 i++, segment++)
7462 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7463 && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
7464 {
7465 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7466 if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
7467 /* xgettext:c-format */
7468 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: segment alignment of %#"
7469 PRIx64 " is too large"),
7470 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_align);
7471 else
7472 maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
7473 }
7474
7475 if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
7476 bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
7477 }
7478
7479 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7480 }
7481
7482 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7483
7484 bfd_boolean
7485 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7486 asection *isec,
7487 bfd *obfd,
7488 asection *osec,
7489 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7490
7491 {
7492 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7493 bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
7494 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
7495
7496 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7497 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7498 return TRUE;
7499
7500 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
7501
7502 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
7503 section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
7504 set to something different. For a final link allow some flags
7505 that the linker clears to differ. */
7506 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
7507 && (osec->flags == isec->flags
7508 || (final_link
7509 && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
7510 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
7511 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
7512
7513 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7514 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7515 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
7516
7517 /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7518 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
7519 elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr.sh_info
7520 = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.sh_info;
7521
7522 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7523 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7524 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7525 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7526 if ((link_info == NULL
7527 || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
7528 && (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
7529 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0))
7530 {
7531 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
7532 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
7533 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7534 elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
7535 }
7536
7537 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7538 if (!final_link && (ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
7539 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7540 & SHF_COMPRESSED);
7541
7542 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7543
7544 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7545 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7546 may be NULL at this point. */
7547 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
7548 {
7549 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7550 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
7551 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
7552 }
7553
7554 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
7555
7556 return TRUE;
7557 }
7558
7559 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7560 field, and sometimes the info field. */
7561
7562 bfd_boolean
7563 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7564 asection *isec,
7565 bfd *obfd,
7566 asection *osec)
7567 {
7568 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7569
7570 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7571 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7572 return TRUE;
7573
7574 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7575 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7576
7577 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
7578
7579 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
7580 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
7581 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
7582 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
7583 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
7584
7585 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
7586 NULL);
7587 }
7588
7589 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7590 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7591 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7592 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7593 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7594 from the linker. */
7595
7596 bfd_boolean
7597 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7598 {
7599 asection *isec;
7600
7601 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7602 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7603 {
7604 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7605 asection *s = first;
7606 bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7607
7608 while (s != NULL)
7609 {
7610 /* If this member section is being output but the
7611 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7612 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7613 if (s->output_section != discarded
7614 && isec->output_section == discarded)
7615 {
7616 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7617 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7618 }
7619 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
7620 but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
7621 else if (s->output_section == discarded
7622 && isec->output_section != discarded)
7623 {
7624 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
7625 removed += 4;
7626 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
7627 && (elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7628 removed += 4;
7629 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
7630 && (elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7631 removed += 4;
7632 }
7633 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7634 if (s == first)
7635 break;
7636 }
7637 if (removed != 0)
7638 {
7639 if (discarded != NULL)
7640 {
7641 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7642 adjust the input section size. */
7643 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7644 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7645 isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7646 if (isec->size <= 4)
7647 {
7648 isec->size = 0;
7649 isec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7650 }
7651 }
7652 else
7653 {
7654 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7655 objcopy. */
7656 isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7657 if (isec->output_section->size <= 4)
7658 {
7659 isec->output_section->size = 0;
7660 isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7661 }
7662 }
7663 }
7664 }
7665
7666 return TRUE;
7667 }
7668
7669 /* Copy private header information. */
7670
7671 bfd_boolean
7672 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7673 {
7674 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7675 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7676 return TRUE;
7677
7678 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7679 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7680 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7681 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7682 already been worked out. */
7683 if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
7684 {
7685 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
7686 return FALSE;
7687 }
7688
7689 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
7690 }
7691
7692 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
7693 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
7694 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
7695 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
7696 swap_out_syms function. */
7697
7698 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
7699 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
7700 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
7701 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
7702 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
7703
7704 bfd_boolean
7705 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
7706 asymbol *isymarg,
7707 bfd *obfd,
7708 asymbol *osymarg)
7709 {
7710 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
7711
7712 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7713 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7714 return TRUE;
7715
7716 isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
7717 osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
7718
7719 if (isym != NULL
7720 && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
7721 && osym != NULL
7722 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
7723 {
7724 unsigned int shndx;
7725
7726 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7727 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
7728 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
7729 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
7730 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
7731 else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
7732 shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
7733 else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
7734 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
7735 else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
7736 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
7737 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7738 }
7739
7740 return TRUE;
7741 }
7742
7743 /* Swap out the symbols. */
7744
7745 static bfd_boolean
7746 swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
7747 struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
7748 int relocatable_p)
7749 {
7750 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7751 int symcount;
7752 asymbol **syms;
7753 struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
7754 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7755 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
7756 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
7757 struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
7758 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
7759 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
7760 unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
7761 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
7762 int idx;
7763 unsigned int num_locals;
7764 bfd_size_type amt;
7765 bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
7766
7767 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
7768 return FALSE;
7769
7770 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
7771 stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
7772 if (stt == NULL)
7773 return FALSE;
7774
7775 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7776 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
7777 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7778 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
7779 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
7780 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
7781 symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
7782 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
7783
7784 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
7785 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
7786
7787 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
7788 symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1)
7789 * sizeof (*symstrtab));
7790 if (symstrtab == NULL)
7791 {
7792 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7793 return FALSE;
7794 }
7795
7796 outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
7797 bed->s->sizeof_sym);
7798 if (outbound_syms == NULL)
7799 {
7800 error_return:
7801 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7802 free (symstrtab);
7803 return FALSE;
7804 }
7805 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
7806 outbound_syms_index = 0;
7807
7808 outbound_shndx = NULL;
7809 outbound_shndx_index = 0;
7810
7811 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7812 {
7813 symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
7814 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
7815 {
7816 amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7817 outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *)
7818 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
7819 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
7820 goto error_return;
7821
7822 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
7823 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
7824 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
7825 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7826 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7827 }
7828 /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
7829 }
7830
7831 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
7832 {
7833 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
7834 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7835 sym.st_name = 0;
7836 sym.st_value = 0;
7837 sym.st_size = 0;
7838 sym.st_info = 0;
7839 sym.st_other = 0;
7840 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
7841 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7842 symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
7843 symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7844 symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7845 outbound_syms_index++;
7846 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7847 outbound_shndx_index++;
7848 }
7849
7850 name_local_sections
7851 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
7852 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
7853
7854 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
7855 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
7856 {
7857 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7858 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
7859 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
7860 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
7861 int type;
7862
7863 if (!name_local_sections
7864 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7865 {
7866 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
7867 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
7868 }
7869 else
7870 {
7871 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
7872 to get the final offset for st_name. */
7873 sym.st_name
7874 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
7875 FALSE);
7876 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7877 goto error_return;
7878 }
7879
7880 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
7881
7882 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
7883 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7884 {
7885 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
7886 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
7887 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
7888 sym.st_size = value;
7889 if (type_ptr == NULL
7890 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
7891 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
7892 else
7893 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
7894 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
7895 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
7896 }
7897 else
7898 {
7899 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
7900 unsigned int shndx;
7901
7902 if (sec->output_section)
7903 {
7904 value += sec->output_offset;
7905 sec = sec->output_section;
7906 }
7907
7908 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
7909 if (! relocatable_p)
7910 value += sec->vma;
7911 sym.st_value = value;
7912 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
7913
7914 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
7915 && type_ptr != NULL
7916 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
7917 {
7918 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
7919 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
7920 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
7921 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7922 switch (shndx)
7923 {
7924 case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
7925 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
7926 break;
7927 case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
7928 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
7929 break;
7930 case MAP_STRTAB:
7931 shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
7932 break;
7933 case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
7934 shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
7935 break;
7936 case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
7937 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7938 shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
7939 break;
7940 default:
7941 shndx = SHN_ABS;
7942 break;
7943 }
7944 }
7945 else
7946 {
7947 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
7948
7949 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7950 {
7951 asection *sec2;
7952
7953 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
7954 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
7955 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
7956 demand of applications. For example, it
7957 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
7958 section of a symbol to be a section that is
7959 actually in the output file. */
7960 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
7961 if (sec2 != NULL)
7962 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
7963 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7964 {
7965 /* xgettext:c-format */
7966 _bfd_error_handler
7967 (_("unable to find equivalent output section"
7968 " for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
7969 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
7970 sec->name);
7971 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7972 goto error_return;
7973 }
7974 }
7975 }
7976
7977 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7978 }
7979
7980 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
7981 type = STT_TLS;
7982 else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
7983 type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
7984 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
7985 type = STT_FUNC;
7986 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
7987 type = STT_OBJECT;
7988 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
7989 type = STT_RELC;
7990 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
7991 type = STT_SRELC;
7992 else
7993 type = STT_NOTYPE;
7994
7995 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
7996 type = STT_TLS;
7997
7998 /* Processor-specific types. */
7999 if (type_ptr != NULL
8000 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8001 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8002 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
8003
8004 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
8005 {
8006 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8007 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8008 else
8009 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
8010 }
8011 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
8012 {
8013 if (type != STT_TLS)
8014 {
8015 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON))
8016 type = ((abfd->flags & BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON)
8017 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8018 else
8019 type = ((flags & BSF_ELF_COMMON) != 0
8020 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8021 }
8022 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
8023 }
8024 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
8025 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
8026 ? STB_WEAK
8027 : STB_GLOBAL),
8028 type);
8029 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
8030 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
8031 else
8032 {
8033 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
8034
8035 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
8036 bind = STB_LOCAL;
8037 else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
8038 bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
8039 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
8040 bind = STB_WEAK;
8041 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8042 bind = STB_GLOBAL;
8043
8044 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
8045 }
8046
8047 if (type_ptr != NULL)
8048 {
8049 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
8050 sym.st_target_internal
8051 = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
8052 }
8053 else
8054 {
8055 sym.st_other = 0;
8056 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8057 }
8058
8059 idx++;
8060 symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
8061 symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8062 symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8063
8064 outbound_syms_index++;
8065 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8066 outbound_shndx_index++;
8067 }
8068
8069 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
8070 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
8071
8072 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
8073 for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
8074 {
8075 struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
8076 if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8077 elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
8078 else
8079 elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
8080 elfsym->sym.st_name);
8081 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
8082 (outbound_syms
8083 + (elfsym->dest_index
8084 * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
8085 (outbound_shndx
8086 + (elfsym->destshndx_index
8087 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
8088 }
8089 free (symstrtab);
8090
8091 *sttp = stt;
8092 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
8093 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8094 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
8095 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
8096 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
8097 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
8098 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
8099 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
8100
8101 return TRUE;
8102 }
8103
8104 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
8105
8106 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
8107 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
8108 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
8109
8110 long
8111 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8112 {
8113 long symcount;
8114 long symtab_size;
8115 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8116
8117 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8118 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8119 if (symcount > 0)
8120 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8121
8122 return symtab_size;
8123 }
8124
8125 long
8126 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8127 {
8128 long symcount;
8129 long symtab_size;
8130 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
8131
8132 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8133 {
8134 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8135 return -1;
8136 }
8137
8138 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8139 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8140 if (symcount > 0)
8141 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8142
8143 return symtab_size;
8144 }
8145
8146 long
8147 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8148 sec_ptr asect)
8149 {
8150 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
8151 }
8152
8153 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8154
8155 long
8156 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8157 sec_ptr section,
8158 arelent **relptr,
8159 asymbol **symbols)
8160 {
8161 arelent *tblptr;
8162 unsigned int i;
8163 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8164
8165 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
8166 return -1;
8167
8168 tblptr = section->relocation;
8169 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
8170 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
8171
8172 *relptr = NULL;
8173
8174 return section->reloc_count;
8175 }
8176
8177 long
8178 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
8179 {
8180 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8181 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
8182
8183 if (symcount >= 0)
8184 bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8185 return symcount;
8186 }
8187
8188 long
8189 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
8190 asymbol **allocation)
8191 {
8192 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8193 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
8194
8195 if (symcount >= 0)
8196 bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8197 return symcount;
8198 }
8199
8200 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8201 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8202 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8203 dynamic reloc section. */
8204
8205 long
8206 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8207 {
8208 long ret;
8209 asection *s;
8210
8211 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8212 {
8213 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8214 return -1;
8215 }
8216
8217 ret = sizeof (arelent *);
8218 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8219 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8220 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8221 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8222 ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
8223 * sizeof (arelent *));
8224
8225 return ret;
8226 }
8227
8228 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8229 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8230 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8231 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8232 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8233 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8234 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8235
8236 long
8237 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8238 arelent **storage,
8239 asymbol **syms)
8240 {
8241 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
8242 asection *s;
8243 long ret;
8244
8245 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8246 {
8247 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8248 return -1;
8249 }
8250
8251 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
8252 ret = 0;
8253 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8254 {
8255 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8256 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8257 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8258 {
8259 arelent *p;
8260 long count, i;
8261
8262 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
8263 return -1;
8264 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8265 p = s->relocation;
8266 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
8267 *storage++ = p++;
8268 ret += count;
8269 }
8270 }
8271
8272 *storage = NULL;
8273
8274 return ret;
8275 }
8276 \f
8277 /* Read in the version information. */
8278
8279 bfd_boolean
8280 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
8281 {
8282 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
8283 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
8284
8285 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
8286 {
8287 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8288 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
8289 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
8290 unsigned int i;
8291 bfd_byte *contents_end;
8292
8293 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
8294
8295 if (hdr->sh_info == 0
8296 || hdr->sh_info > hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
8297 {
8298 error_return_bad_verref:
8299 _bfd_error_handler
8300 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
8301 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8302 error_return_verref:
8303 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
8304 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
8305 goto error_return;
8306 }
8307
8308 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8309 if (contents == NULL)
8310 goto error_return_verref;
8311
8312 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8313 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8314 goto error_return_verref;
8315
8316 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
8317 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
8318
8319 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
8320 goto error_return_verref;
8321
8322 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
8323 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
8324 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
8325 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
8326 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
8327 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
8328 {
8329 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
8330 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
8331 unsigned int j;
8332
8333 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
8334
8335 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
8336
8337 iverneed->vn_filename =
8338 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8339 iverneed->vn_file);
8340 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
8341 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8342
8343 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
8344 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
8345 else
8346 {
8347 iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
8348 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
8349 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
8350 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
8351 goto error_return_verref;
8352 }
8353
8354 if (iverneed->vn_aux
8355 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8356 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8357
8358 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8359 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
8360 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
8361 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
8362 {
8363 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
8364
8365 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
8366 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8367 ivernaux->vna_name);
8368 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
8369 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8370
8371 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
8372 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
8373
8374 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
8375 if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
8376 {
8377 iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
8378 break;
8379 }
8380 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
8381 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
8382
8383 if (ivernaux->vna_next
8384 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
8385 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8386
8387 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8388 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
8389 }
8390
8391 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
8392 if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
8393 break;
8394 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
8395 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
8396
8397 if (iverneed->vn_next
8398 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8399 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8400
8401 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
8402 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
8403 }
8404 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
8405
8406 free (contents);
8407 contents = NULL;
8408 }
8409
8410 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
8411 {
8412 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8413 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
8414 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8415 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
8416 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
8417 unsigned int i;
8418 unsigned int maxidx;
8419 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
8420
8421 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
8422
8423 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
8424 {
8425 error_return_bad_verdef:
8426 _bfd_error_handler
8427 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
8428 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8429 error_return_verdef:
8430 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
8431 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
8432 goto error_return;
8433 }
8434
8435 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8436 if (contents == NULL)
8437 goto error_return_verdef;
8438 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8439 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8440 goto error_return_verdef;
8441
8442 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
8443 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
8444 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
8445 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
8446 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
8447 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
8448
8449 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8450 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8451 the maximum. */
8452 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8453 maxidx = 0;
8454 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
8455 {
8456 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8457
8458 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
8459 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8460 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
8461 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
8462
8463 if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
8464 break;
8465
8466 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
8467 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8468 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8469
8470 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8471 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
8472 }
8473
8474 if (default_imported_symver)
8475 {
8476 if (freeidx > maxidx)
8477 maxidx = ++freeidx;
8478 else
8479 freeidx = ++maxidx;
8480 }
8481
8482 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8483 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8484 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8485 goto error_return_verdef;
8486
8487 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
8488
8489 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8490 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
8491 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
8492 {
8493 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
8494 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8495 unsigned int j;
8496
8497 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8498
8499 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
8500 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8501
8502 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
8503 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
8504
8505 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8506
8507 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
8508 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
8509 else
8510 {
8511 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8512 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
8513 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
8514 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8515 goto error_return_verdef;
8516 }
8517
8518 if (iverdef->vd_aux
8519 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8520 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8521
8522 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8523 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
8524 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8525 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
8526 {
8527 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
8528
8529 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
8530 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8531 iverdaux->vda_name);
8532 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
8533 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8534
8535 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
8536 if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
8537 {
8538 iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
8539 break;
8540 }
8541 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
8542 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
8543
8544 if (iverdaux->vda_next
8545 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
8546 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8547
8548 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8549 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
8550 }
8551
8552 iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
8553 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
8554 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
8555
8556 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8557 if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
8558 break;
8559 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
8560 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
8561
8562 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8563 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
8564 }
8565
8566 free (contents);
8567 contents = NULL;
8568 }
8569 else if (default_imported_symver)
8570 {
8571 if (freeidx < 3)
8572 freeidx = 3;
8573 else
8574 freeidx++;
8575
8576 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8577 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8578 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8579 goto error_return;
8580
8581 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
8582 }
8583
8584 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
8585 if (default_imported_symver)
8586 {
8587 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8588 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8589
8590 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
8591
8592 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
8593 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
8594 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
8595 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
8596
8597 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8598
8599 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
8600 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
8601 goto error_return_verdef;
8602 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8603 iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8604 bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
8605 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8606 goto error_return_verdef;
8607
8608 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8609 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
8610 }
8611
8612 return TRUE;
8613
8614 error_return:
8615 if (contents != NULL)
8616 free (contents);
8617 return FALSE;
8618 }
8619 \f
8620 asymbol *
8621 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
8622 {
8623 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
8624
8625 newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * newsym);
8626 if (!newsym)
8627 return NULL;
8628 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
8629 return &newsym->symbol;
8630 }
8631
8632 void
8633 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8634 asymbol *symbol,
8635 symbol_info *ret)
8636 {
8637 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
8638 }
8639
8640 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
8641 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
8642 override it. */
8643
8644 bfd_boolean
8645 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8646 const char *name)
8647 {
8648 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
8649 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
8650 return TRUE;
8651
8652 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
8653 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
8654 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
8655 return TRUE;
8656
8657 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
8658 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
8659 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
8660 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
8661 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
8662 we treat such symbols as local. */
8663 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
8664 return TRUE;
8665
8666 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
8667 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
8668 These labels have the form:
8669
8670 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
8671
8672 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
8673
8674 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
8675 so we only need to match the rest. */
8676 if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
8677 {
8678 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
8679 const char * p;
8680 char c;
8681
8682 for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
8683 {
8684 if (c == 1 || c == 2)
8685 {
8686 if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
8687 /* A fake symbol. */
8688 return TRUE;
8689
8690 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
8691 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
8692 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
8693 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
8694 other than some kind of local ? */
8695 ret = TRUE;
8696 }
8697
8698 if (! ISDIGIT (c))
8699 {
8700 ret = FALSE;
8701 break;
8702 }
8703 }
8704 return ret;
8705 }
8706
8707 return FALSE;
8708 }
8709
8710 alent *
8711 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8712 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8713 {
8714 abort ();
8715 return NULL;
8716 }
8717
8718 bfd_boolean
8719 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
8720 enum bfd_architecture arch,
8721 unsigned long machine)
8722 {
8723 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
8724 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
8725 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
8726 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
8727 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
8728 return FALSE;
8729
8730 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
8731 }
8732
8733 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
8734 for error reporting. */
8735
8736 bfd_boolean
8737 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
8738 asymbol **symbols,
8739 asection *section,
8740 bfd_vma offset,
8741 const char **filename_ptr,
8742 const char **functionname_ptr,
8743 unsigned int *line_ptr,
8744 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
8745 {
8746 bfd_boolean found;
8747
8748 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
8749 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8750 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
8751 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8752 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)
8753 || _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8754 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8755 line_ptr))
8756 {
8757 if (!*functionname_ptr)
8758 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8759 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
8760 functionname_ptr);
8761 return TRUE;
8762 }
8763
8764 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8765 &found, filename_ptr,
8766 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8767 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
8768 return FALSE;
8769 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
8770 return TRUE;
8771
8772 if (symbols == NULL)
8773 return FALSE;
8774
8775 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8776 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
8777 return FALSE;
8778
8779 *line_ptr = 0;
8780 return TRUE;
8781 }
8782
8783 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
8784
8785 bfd_boolean
8786 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
8787 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
8788 {
8789 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
8790 filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
8791 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8792 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8793 }
8794
8795 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
8796 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
8797 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
8798 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
8799 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
8800
8801 bfd_boolean
8802 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
8803 const char **filename_ptr,
8804 const char **functionname_ptr,
8805 unsigned int *line_ptr)
8806 {
8807 bfd_boolean found;
8808 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
8809 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8810 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8811 return found;
8812 }
8813
8814 int
8815 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8816 {
8817 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8818 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
8819
8820 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8821 {
8822 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
8823
8824 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
8825 {
8826 struct elf_segment_map *m;
8827
8828 phdr_size = 0;
8829 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
8830 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
8831
8832 if (phdr_size == 0)
8833 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
8834 }
8835
8836 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
8837 ret += phdr_size;
8838 }
8839
8840 return ret;
8841 }
8842
8843 bfd_boolean
8844 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
8845 sec_ptr section,
8846 const void *location,
8847 file_ptr offset,
8848 bfd_size_type count)
8849 {
8850 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8851 file_ptr pos;
8852
8853 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
8854 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
8855 return FALSE;
8856
8857 if (!count)
8858 return TRUE;
8859
8860 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
8861 if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
8862 {
8863 /* We must compress this section. Write output to the buffer. */
8864 unsigned char *contents = hdr->contents;
8865 if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size
8866 || (section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0
8867 || contents == NULL)
8868 abort ();
8869 memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
8870 return TRUE;
8871 }
8872 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
8873 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
8874 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
8875 return FALSE;
8876
8877 return TRUE;
8878 }
8879
8880 bfd_boolean
8881 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8882 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8883 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8884 {
8885 abort ();
8886 return FALSE;
8887 }
8888
8889 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
8890
8891 bfd_boolean
8892 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
8893 {
8894 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
8895
8896 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
8897 {
8898 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
8899 reloc_howto_type *howto;
8900
8901 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
8902 equivalent ELF reloc. */
8903
8904 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
8905 {
8906 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8907 {
8908 case 8:
8909 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
8910 break;
8911 case 12:
8912 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
8913 break;
8914 case 16:
8915 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
8916 break;
8917 case 24:
8918 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
8919 break;
8920 case 32:
8921 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
8922 break;
8923 case 64:
8924 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
8925 break;
8926 default:
8927 goto fail;
8928 }
8929
8930 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8931
8932 if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
8933 {
8934 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
8935 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
8936 else
8937 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
8938 }
8939 }
8940 else
8941 {
8942 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8943 {
8944 case 8:
8945 code = BFD_RELOC_8;
8946 break;
8947 case 14:
8948 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
8949 break;
8950 case 16:
8951 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
8952 break;
8953 case 26:
8954 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
8955 break;
8956 case 32:
8957 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
8958 break;
8959 case 64:
8960 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
8961 break;
8962 default:
8963 goto fail;
8964 }
8965
8966 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8967 }
8968
8969 if (howto)
8970 areloc->howto = howto;
8971 else
8972 goto fail;
8973 }
8974
8975 return TRUE;
8976
8977 fail:
8978 /* xgettext:c-format */
8979 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8980 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
8981 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8982 return FALSE;
8983 }
8984
8985 bfd_boolean
8986 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
8987 {
8988 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
8989 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
8990 {
8991 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
8992 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
8993 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8994 }
8995
8996 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
8997 }
8998
8999 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
9000 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
9001 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
9002 this reloc. */
9003
9004 bfd_reloc_status_type
9005 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
9006 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9007 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9008 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9009 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9010 {
9011 return bfd_reloc_ok;
9012 }
9013 \f
9014 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
9015 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
9016 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
9017 out details about the corefile. */
9018
9019 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
9020 /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
9021 # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
9022 # include <sys/procfs.h>
9023 #endif
9024
9025 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
9026 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
9027
9028 static int
9029 elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
9030 {
9031 int pid;
9032
9033 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
9034 if (pid == 0)
9035 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
9036
9037 return pid;
9038 }
9039
9040 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
9041 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
9042 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
9043 overwrite it. */
9044
9045 static bfd_boolean
9046 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
9047 {
9048 asection *sect2;
9049
9050 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
9051 return TRUE;
9052
9053 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
9054 if (sect2 == NULL)
9055 return FALSE;
9056
9057 sect2->size = sect->size;
9058 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
9059 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
9060 return TRUE;
9061 }
9062
9063 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
9064 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
9065 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
9066 such a section already exists.
9067 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
9068 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
9069 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
9070 bfd_boolean
9071 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9072 char *name,
9073 size_t size,
9074 ufile_ptr filepos)
9075 {
9076 char buf[100];
9077 char *threaded_name;
9078 size_t len;
9079 asection *sect;
9080
9081 /* Build the section name. */
9082
9083 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9084 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9085 threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9086 if (threaded_name == NULL)
9087 return FALSE;
9088 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
9089
9090 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
9091 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9092 if (sect == NULL)
9093 return FALSE;
9094 sect->size = size;
9095 sect->filepos = filepos;
9096 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9097
9098 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
9099 }
9100
9101 /* prstatus_t exists on:
9102 solaris 2.5+
9103 linux 2.[01] + glibc
9104 unixware 4.2
9105 */
9106
9107 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9108
9109 static bfd_boolean
9110 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9111 {
9112 size_t size;
9113 int offset;
9114
9115 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
9116 {
9117 prstatus_t prstat;
9118
9119 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9120 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
9121 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9122
9123 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9124 has already been set by another thread. */
9125 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9126 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9127 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9128 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9129
9130 /* pr_who exists on:
9131 solaris 2.5+
9132 unixware 4.2
9133 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9134 linux 2.[01]
9135 */
9136 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9137 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9138 #else
9139 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9140 #endif
9141 }
9142 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9143 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
9144 {
9145 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9146 prstatus32_t prstat;
9147
9148 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9149 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
9150 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9151
9152 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9153 has already been set by another thread. */
9154 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9155 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9156 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9157 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9158
9159 /* pr_who exists on:
9160 solaris 2.5+
9161 unixware 4.2
9162 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9163 linux 2.[01]
9164 */
9165 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9166 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9167 #else
9168 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9169 #endif
9170 }
9171 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9172 else
9173 {
9174 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9175 note size (ie. data object type). */
9176 return TRUE;
9177 }
9178
9179 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9180 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9181 size, note->descpos + offset);
9182 }
9183 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9184
9185 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9186 static bfd_boolean
9187 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9188 char *name,
9189 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9190 {
9191 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
9192 note->descsz, note->descpos);
9193 }
9194
9195 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9196 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9197 data structure apart. */
9198
9199 static bfd_boolean
9200 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9201 {
9202 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9203 }
9204
9205 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9206 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9207 literally. */
9208
9209 static bfd_boolean
9210 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9211 {
9212 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9213 }
9214
9215 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9216 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9217 contents literally. */
9218
9219 static bfd_boolean
9220 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9221 {
9222 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
9223 }
9224
9225 static bfd_boolean
9226 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9227 {
9228 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
9229 }
9230
9231 static bfd_boolean
9232 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9233 {
9234 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
9235 }
9236
9237 static bfd_boolean
9238 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9239 {
9240 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
9241 }
9242
9243 static bfd_boolean
9244 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9245 {
9246 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
9247 }
9248
9249 static bfd_boolean
9250 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9251 {
9252 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
9253 }
9254
9255 static bfd_boolean
9256 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9257 {
9258 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
9259 }
9260
9261 static bfd_boolean
9262 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9263 {
9264 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
9265 }
9266
9267 static bfd_boolean
9268 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9269 {
9270 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
9271 }
9272
9273 static bfd_boolean
9274 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9275 {
9276 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
9277 }
9278
9279 static bfd_boolean
9280 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9281 {
9282 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
9283 }
9284
9285 static bfd_boolean
9286 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9287 {
9288 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
9289 }
9290
9291 static bfd_boolean
9292 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9293 {
9294 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
9295 }
9296
9297 static bfd_boolean
9298 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9299 {
9300 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
9301 }
9302
9303 static bfd_boolean
9304 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9305 {
9306 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note);
9307 }
9308
9309 static bfd_boolean
9310 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9311 {
9312 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note);
9313 }
9314
9315 static bfd_boolean
9316 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9317 {
9318 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
9319 }
9320
9321 static bfd_boolean
9322 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9323 {
9324 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
9325 }
9326
9327 static bfd_boolean
9328 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9329 {
9330 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
9331 }
9332
9333 static bfd_boolean
9334 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9335 {
9336 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
9337 }
9338
9339 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9340 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9341 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9342 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9343 #endif
9344 #endif
9345
9346 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9347 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9348 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9349 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9350 #endif
9351 #endif
9352
9353 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9354 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9355 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9356
9357 char *
9358 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
9359 {
9360 char *dups;
9361 char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
9362 size_t len;
9363
9364 if (end == NULL)
9365 len = max;
9366 else
9367 len = end - start;
9368
9369 dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
9370 if (dups == NULL)
9371 return NULL;
9372
9373 memcpy (dups, start, len);
9374 dups[len] = '\0';
9375
9376 return dups;
9377 }
9378
9379 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9380 static bfd_boolean
9381 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9382 {
9383 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
9384 {
9385 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
9386
9387 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9388
9389 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
9390 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9391 #endif
9392 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9393 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9394 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9395
9396 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9397 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9398 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9399 }
9400 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9401 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
9402 {
9403 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9404 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
9405
9406 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9407
9408 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
9409 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9410 #endif
9411 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9412 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9413 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9414
9415 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9416 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9417 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9418 }
9419 #endif
9420
9421 else
9422 {
9423 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9424 note size (ie. data object type). */
9425 return TRUE;
9426 }
9427
9428 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
9429 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
9430 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
9431
9432 {
9433 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
9434 int n = strlen (command);
9435
9436 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
9437 command[n - 1] = '\0';
9438 }
9439
9440 return TRUE;
9441 }
9442 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
9443
9444 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9445 static bfd_boolean
9446 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9447 {
9448 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
9449 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
9450 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
9451 #endif
9452 )
9453 {
9454 pstatus_t pstat;
9455
9456 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9457
9458 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9459 }
9460 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9461 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
9462 {
9463 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9464 pstatus32_t pstat;
9465
9466 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9467
9468 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9469 }
9470 #endif
9471 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
9472 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
9473 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
9474
9475 return TRUE;
9476 }
9477 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
9478
9479 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9480 static bfd_boolean
9481 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9482 {
9483 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
9484 char buf[100];
9485 char *name;
9486 size_t len;
9487 asection *sect;
9488
9489 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
9490 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
9491 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
9492 #endif
9493 )
9494 return TRUE;
9495
9496 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
9497
9498 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
9499 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
9500 another thread. */
9501 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9502 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
9503
9504 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9505
9506 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9507 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9508 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9509 if (name == NULL)
9510 return FALSE;
9511 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9512
9513 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9514 if (sect == NULL)
9515 return FALSE;
9516
9517 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9518 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9519 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9520 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9521 #endif
9522
9523 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
9524 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
9525 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
9526 #endif
9527
9528 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9529
9530 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9531 return FALSE;
9532
9533 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
9534
9535 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9536 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9537 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9538 if (name == NULL)
9539 return FALSE;
9540 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9541
9542 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9543 if (sect == NULL)
9544 return FALSE;
9545
9546 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9547 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9548 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9549 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9550 #endif
9551
9552 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
9553 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
9554 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
9555 #endif
9556
9557 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9558
9559 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
9560 }
9561 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
9562
9563 static bfd_boolean
9564 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9565 {
9566 char buf[30];
9567 char *name;
9568 size_t len;
9569 asection *sect;
9570 int type;
9571 int is_active_thread;
9572 bfd_vma base_addr;
9573
9574 if (note->descsz < 728)
9575 return TRUE;
9576
9577 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
9578 return TRUE;
9579
9580 type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
9581
9582 switch (type)
9583 {
9584 case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
9585 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
9586 /* process_info.pid */
9587 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9588 /* process_info.signal */
9589 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
9590 break;
9591
9592 case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
9593 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9594 /* thread_info.tid */
9595 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
9596
9597 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9598 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9599 if (name == NULL)
9600 return FALSE;
9601
9602 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9603
9604 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9605 if (sect == NULL)
9606 return FALSE;
9607
9608 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9609 sect->size = 716;
9610 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9611 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
9612 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9613
9614 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
9615 is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9616
9617 if (is_active_thread)
9618 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9619 return FALSE;
9620 break;
9621
9622 case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
9623 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
9624 /* module_info.base_address */
9625 base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
9626 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
9627
9628 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9629 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9630 if (name == NULL)
9631 return FALSE;
9632
9633 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9634
9635 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9636
9637 if (sect == NULL)
9638 return FALSE;
9639
9640 sect->size = note->descsz;
9641 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9642 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9643 break;
9644
9645 default:
9646 return TRUE;
9647 }
9648
9649 return TRUE;
9650 }
9651
9652 static bfd_boolean
9653 elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9654 {
9655 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9656
9657 switch (note->type)
9658 {
9659 default:
9660 return TRUE;
9661
9662 case NT_PRSTATUS:
9663 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
9664 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
9665 return TRUE;
9666 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9667 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
9668 #else
9669 return TRUE;
9670 #endif
9671
9672 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9673 case NT_PSTATUS:
9674 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
9675 #endif
9676
9677 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9678 case NT_LWPSTATUS:
9679 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
9680 #endif
9681
9682 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
9683 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
9684
9685 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
9686 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
9687
9688 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
9689 if (note->namesz == 6
9690 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9691 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
9692 else
9693 return TRUE;
9694
9695 case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
9696 if (note->namesz == 6
9697 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9698 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
9699 else
9700 return TRUE;
9701
9702 case NT_PPC_VMX:
9703 if (note->namesz == 6
9704 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9705 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
9706 else
9707 return TRUE;
9708
9709 case NT_PPC_VSX:
9710 if (note->namesz == 6
9711 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9712 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
9713 else
9714 return TRUE;
9715
9716 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
9717 if (note->namesz == 6
9718 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9719 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
9720 else
9721 return TRUE;
9722
9723 case NT_S390_TIMER:
9724 if (note->namesz == 6
9725 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9726 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
9727 else
9728 return TRUE;
9729
9730 case NT_S390_TODCMP:
9731 if (note->namesz == 6
9732 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9733 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
9734 else
9735 return TRUE;
9736
9737 case NT_S390_TODPREG:
9738 if (note->namesz == 6
9739 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9740 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
9741 else
9742 return TRUE;
9743
9744 case NT_S390_CTRS:
9745 if (note->namesz == 6
9746 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9747 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
9748 else
9749 return TRUE;
9750
9751 case NT_S390_PREFIX:
9752 if (note->namesz == 6
9753 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9754 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
9755 else
9756 return TRUE;
9757
9758 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
9759 if (note->namesz == 6
9760 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9761 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
9762 else
9763 return TRUE;
9764
9765 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
9766 if (note->namesz == 6
9767 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9768 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
9769 else
9770 return TRUE;
9771
9772 case NT_S390_TDB:
9773 if (note->namesz == 6
9774 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9775 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
9776 else
9777 return TRUE;
9778
9779 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
9780 if (note->namesz == 6
9781 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9782 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
9783 else
9784 return TRUE;
9785
9786 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
9787 if (note->namesz == 6
9788 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9789 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
9790 else
9791 return TRUE;
9792
9793 case NT_S390_GS_CB:
9794 if (note->namesz == 6
9795 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9796 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd, note);
9797 else
9798 return TRUE;
9799
9800 case NT_S390_GS_BC:
9801 if (note->namesz == 6
9802 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9803 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd, note);
9804 else
9805 return TRUE;
9806
9807 case NT_ARM_VFP:
9808 if (note->namesz == 6
9809 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9810 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
9811 else
9812 return TRUE;
9813
9814 case NT_ARM_TLS:
9815 if (note->namesz == 6
9816 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9817 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
9818 else
9819 return TRUE;
9820
9821 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
9822 if (note->namesz == 6
9823 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9824 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
9825 else
9826 return TRUE;
9827
9828 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
9829 if (note->namesz == 6
9830 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9831 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
9832 else
9833 return TRUE;
9834
9835 case NT_PRPSINFO:
9836 case NT_PSINFO:
9837 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
9838 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
9839 return TRUE;
9840 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9841 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
9842 #else
9843 return TRUE;
9844 #endif
9845
9846 case NT_AUXV:
9847 {
9848 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9849 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9850
9851 if (sect == NULL)
9852 return FALSE;
9853 sect->size = note->descsz;
9854 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9855 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9856
9857 return TRUE;
9858 }
9859
9860 case NT_FILE:
9861 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
9862 note);
9863
9864 case NT_SIGINFO:
9865 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
9866 note);
9867
9868 }
9869 }
9870
9871 static bfd_boolean
9872 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9873 {
9874 struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
9875
9876 if (note->descsz == 0)
9877 return FALSE;
9878
9879 build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
9880 if (build_id == NULL)
9881 return FALSE;
9882
9883 build_id->size = note->descsz;
9884 memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9885 abfd->build_id = build_id;
9886
9887 return TRUE;
9888 }
9889
9890 static bfd_boolean
9891 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9892 {
9893 switch (note->type)
9894 {
9895 default:
9896 return TRUE;
9897
9898 case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0:
9899 return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd, note);
9900
9901 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
9902 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
9903 }
9904 }
9905
9906 static bfd_boolean
9907 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9908 {
9909 struct sdt_note *cur =
9910 (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
9911 + note->descsz);
9912
9913 cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
9914 cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
9915 memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9916
9917 elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
9918
9919 return TRUE;
9920 }
9921
9922 static bfd_boolean
9923 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9924 {
9925 switch (note->type)
9926 {
9927 case NT_STAPSDT:
9928 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
9929
9930 default:
9931 return TRUE;
9932 }
9933 }
9934
9935 static bfd_boolean
9936 elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9937 {
9938 size_t offset;
9939
9940 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
9941 {
9942 case ELFCLASS32:
9943 if (note->descsz < 108)
9944 return FALSE;
9945 break;
9946
9947 case ELFCLASS64:
9948 if (note->descsz < 120)
9949 return FALSE;
9950 break;
9951
9952 default:
9953 return FALSE;
9954 }
9955
9956 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
9957 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
9958 return FALSE;
9959
9960 offset = 4;
9961
9962 /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
9963 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
9964 offset += 4;
9965 else
9966 {
9967 offset += 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
9968 offset += 8;
9969 }
9970
9971 /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
9972 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9973 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 17);
9974 offset += 17;
9975
9976 /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
9977 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9978 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 81);
9979 offset += 81;
9980
9981 /* Padding before pr_pid. */
9982 offset += 2;
9983
9984 /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
9985 if (note->descsz < offset + 4)
9986 return TRUE;
9987
9988 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
9989 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9990
9991 return TRUE;
9992 }
9993
9994 static bfd_boolean
9995 elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9996 {
9997 size_t offset;
9998 size_t size;
9999 size_t min_size;
10000
10001 /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
10002 Also compute minimum size of this note. */
10003 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10004 {
10005 case ELFCLASS32:
10006 offset = 4 + 4;
10007 min_size = offset + (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
10008 break;
10009
10010 case ELFCLASS64:
10011 offset = 4 + 4 + 8; /* Includes padding before pr_statussz. */
10012 min_size = offset + (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
10013 break;
10014
10015 default:
10016 return FALSE;
10017 }
10018
10019 if (note->descsz < min_size)
10020 return FALSE;
10021
10022 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10023 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10024 return FALSE;
10025
10026 /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
10027 /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
10028 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10029 {
10030 size = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10031 offset += 4 * 2;
10032 }
10033 else
10034 {
10035 size = bfd_h_get_64 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10036 offset += 8 * 2;
10037 }
10038
10039 /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
10040 offset += 4;
10041
10042 /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
10043 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
10044 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10045 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10046 offset += 4;
10047
10048 /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
10049 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
10050 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10051 offset += 4;
10052
10053 /* Padding before pr_reg. */
10054 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
10055 offset += 4;
10056
10057 /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note. */
10058 if ((note->descsz - offset) < size)
10059 return FALSE;
10060
10061 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
10062 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
10063 size, note->descpos + offset);
10064 }
10065
10066 static bfd_boolean
10067 elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10068 {
10069 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10070
10071 switch (note->type)
10072 {
10073 case NT_PRSTATUS:
10074 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus)
10075 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10076 return TRUE;
10077 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd, note);
10078
10079 case NT_FPREGSET:
10080 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10081
10082 case NT_PRPSINFO:
10083 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd, note);
10084
10085 case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC:
10086 if (note->namesz == 8)
10087 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".thrmisc", note);
10088 else
10089 return TRUE;
10090
10091 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_PROC:
10092 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.proc",
10093 note);
10094
10095 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_FILES:
10096 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.files",
10097 note);
10098
10099 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_VMMAP:
10100 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.vmmap",
10101 note);
10102
10103 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV:
10104 {
10105 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10106 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10107
10108 if (sect == NULL)
10109 return FALSE;
10110 sect->size = note->descsz - 4;
10111 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 4;
10112 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10113
10114 return TRUE;
10115 }
10116
10117 case NT_X86_XSTATE:
10118 if (note->namesz == 8)
10119 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10120 else
10121 return TRUE;
10122
10123 case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO:
10124 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
10125 note);
10126
10127 case NT_ARM_VFP:
10128 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10129
10130 default:
10131 return TRUE;
10132 }
10133 }
10134
10135 static bfd_boolean
10136 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
10137 {
10138 char *cp;
10139
10140 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
10141 if (cp != NULL)
10142 {
10143 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
10144 return TRUE;
10145 }
10146 return FALSE;
10147 }
10148
10149 static bfd_boolean
10150 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10151 {
10152 if (note->descsz <= 0x7c + 31)
10153 return FALSE;
10154
10155 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10156 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10157 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10158
10159 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
10160 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10161 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
10162
10163 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10164 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10165 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
10166
10167 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
10168 note);
10169 }
10170
10171 static bfd_boolean
10172 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10173 {
10174 int lwp;
10175
10176 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
10177 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
10178
10179 if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
10180 {
10181 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
10182 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10183 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10184 creates a core file. */
10185
10186 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10187 }
10188
10189 /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
10190 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10191 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10192 understand it. */
10193
10194 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
10195 return TRUE;
10196
10197
10198 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
10199 {
10200 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10201 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10202
10203 case bfd_arch_alpha:
10204 case bfd_arch_sparc:
10205 switch (note->type)
10206 {
10207 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
10208 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10209
10210 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
10211 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10212
10213 default:
10214 return TRUE;
10215 }
10216
10217 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
10218 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
10219
10220 default:
10221 switch (note->type)
10222 {
10223 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
10224 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10225
10226 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
10227 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10228
10229 default:
10230 return TRUE;
10231 }
10232 }
10233 /* NOTREACHED */
10234 }
10235
10236 static bfd_boolean
10237 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10238 {
10239 if (note->descsz <= 0x48 + 31)
10240 return FALSE;
10241
10242 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10243 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10244 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10245
10246 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
10247 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10248 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
10249
10250 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10251 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10252 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
10253
10254 return TRUE;
10255 }
10256
10257 static bfd_boolean
10258 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10259 {
10260 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
10261 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10262
10263 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
10264 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10265
10266 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
10267 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10268
10269 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
10270 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
10271
10272 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
10273 {
10274 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10275 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10276
10277 if (sect == NULL)
10278 return FALSE;
10279 sect->size = note->descsz;
10280 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10281 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10282
10283 return TRUE;
10284 }
10285
10286 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
10287 {
10288 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
10289 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10290
10291 if (sect == NULL)
10292 return FALSE;
10293 sect->size = note->descsz;
10294 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10295 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10296
10297 return TRUE;
10298 }
10299
10300 return TRUE;
10301 }
10302
10303 static bfd_boolean
10304 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
10305 {
10306 void *ddata = note->descdata;
10307 char buf[100];
10308 char *name;
10309 asection *sect;
10310 short sig;
10311 unsigned flags;
10312
10313 if (note->descsz < 16)
10314 return FALSE;
10315
10316 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
10317 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
10318
10319 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
10320 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
10321
10322 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
10323 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
10324
10325 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
10326 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
10327 {
10328 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
10329 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10330 }
10331
10332 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
10333 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
10334 thread just in case. */
10335 if (flags & 0x00000080)
10336 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10337
10338 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
10339 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
10340
10341 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10342 if (name == NULL)
10343 return FALSE;
10344 strcpy (name, buf);
10345
10346 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10347 if (sect == NULL)
10348 return FALSE;
10349
10350 sect->size = note->descsz;
10351 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10352 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10353
10354 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
10355 }
10356
10357 static bfd_boolean
10358 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
10359 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
10360 long tid,
10361 char *base)
10362 {
10363 char buf[100];
10364 char *name;
10365 asection *sect;
10366
10367 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
10368 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
10369
10370 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10371 if (name == NULL)
10372 return FALSE;
10373 strcpy (name, buf);
10374
10375 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10376 if (sect == NULL)
10377 return FALSE;
10378
10379 sect->size = note->descsz;
10380 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10381 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10382
10383 /* This is the current thread. */
10384 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
10385 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
10386
10387 return TRUE;
10388 }
10389
10390 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
10391 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
10392 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
10393 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
10394
10395 static bfd_boolean
10396 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10397 {
10398 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
10399 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
10400 function. */
10401 static long tid = 1;
10402
10403 switch (note->type)
10404 {
10405 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
10406 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
10407 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
10408 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
10409 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
10410 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
10411 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
10412 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
10413 default:
10414 return TRUE;
10415 }
10416 }
10417
10418 static bfd_boolean
10419 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10420 {
10421 char *name;
10422 asection *sect;
10423 size_t len;
10424
10425 /* Use note name as section name. */
10426 len = note->namesz;
10427 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10428 if (name == NULL)
10429 return FALSE;
10430 memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
10431 name[len - 1] = '\0';
10432
10433 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10434 if (sect == NULL)
10435 return FALSE;
10436
10437 sect->size = note->descsz;
10438 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10439 sect->alignment_power = 1;
10440
10441 return TRUE;
10442 }
10443
10444 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
10445
10446 Inputs:
10447 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
10448 name of note
10449 type of note
10450 data for note
10451 size of data for note
10452
10453 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
10454 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
10455 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
10456 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
10457
10458 Return:
10459 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
10460
10461 char *
10462 elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
10463 char *buf,
10464 int *bufsiz,
10465 const char *name,
10466 int type,
10467 const void *input,
10468 int size)
10469 {
10470 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
10471 size_t namesz;
10472 size_t newspace;
10473 char *dest;
10474
10475 namesz = 0;
10476 if (name != NULL)
10477 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
10478
10479 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
10480
10481 buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
10482 if (buf == NULL)
10483 return buf;
10484 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
10485 *bufsiz += newspace;
10486 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
10487 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
10488 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
10489 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
10490 dest = xnp->name;
10491 if (name != NULL)
10492 {
10493 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
10494 dest += namesz;
10495 while (namesz & 3)
10496 {
10497 *dest++ = '\0';
10498 ++namesz;
10499 }
10500 }
10501 memcpy (dest, input, size);
10502 dest += size;
10503 while (size & 3)
10504 {
10505 *dest++ = '\0';
10506 ++size;
10507 }
10508 return buf;
10509 }
10510
10511 /* gcc-8 warns (*) on all the strncpy calls in this function about
10512 possible string truncation. The "truncation" is not a bug. We
10513 have an external representation of structs with fields that are not
10514 necessarily NULL terminated and corresponding internal
10515 representation fields that are one larger so that they can always
10516 be NULL terminated.
10517 gcc versions between 4.2 and 4.6 do not allow pragma control of
10518 diagnostics inside functions, giving a hard error if you try to use
10519 the finer control available with later versions.
10520 gcc prior to 4.2 warns about diagnostic push and pop.
10521 gcc-5, gcc-6 and gcc-7 warn that -Wstringop-truncation is unknown,
10522 unless you also add #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragma".
10523 (*) Depending on your system header files! */
10524 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
10525 # pragma GCC diagnostic push
10526 # pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstringop-truncation"
10527 #endif
10528 char *
10529 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
10530 char *buf,
10531 int *bufsiz,
10532 const char *fname,
10533 const char *psargs)
10534 {
10535 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10536
10537 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10538 {
10539 char *ret;
10540 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10541 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
10542 if (ret != NULL)
10543 return ret;
10544 }
10545
10546 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10547 # if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10548 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10549 {
10550 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10551 psinfo32_t data;
10552 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10553 # else
10554 prpsinfo32_t data;
10555 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10556 # endif
10557
10558 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10559 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10560 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10561 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10562 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10563 }
10564 else
10565 # endif
10566 {
10567 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10568 psinfo_t data;
10569 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10570 # else
10571 prpsinfo_t data;
10572 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10573 # endif
10574
10575 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10576 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10577 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10578 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10579 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10580 }
10581 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
10582
10583 free (buf);
10584 return NULL;
10585 }
10586 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
10587 # pragma GCC diagnostic pop
10588 #endif
10589
10590 char *
10591 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
10592 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10593 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10594 {
10595 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16)
10596 {
10597 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data;
10598
10599 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10600 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10601 &data, sizeof (data));
10602 }
10603 else
10604 {
10605 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data;
10606
10607 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10608 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10609 &data, sizeof (data));
10610 }
10611 }
10612
10613 char *
10614 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
10615 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10616 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10617 {
10618 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16)
10619 {
10620 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data;
10621
10622 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10623 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10624 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10625 }
10626 else
10627 {
10628 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data;
10629
10630 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10631 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10632 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10633 }
10634 }
10635
10636 char *
10637 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
10638 char *buf,
10639 int *bufsiz,
10640 long pid,
10641 int cursig,
10642 const void *gregs)
10643 {
10644 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10645
10646 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10647 {
10648 char *ret;
10649 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10650 NT_PRSTATUS,
10651 pid, cursig, gregs);
10652 if (ret != NULL)
10653 return ret;
10654 }
10655
10656 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10657 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
10658 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10659 {
10660 prstatus32_t prstat;
10661
10662 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10663 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10664 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10665 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10666 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10667 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10668 }
10669 else
10670 #endif
10671 {
10672 prstatus_t prstat;
10673
10674 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10675 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10676 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10677 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10678 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10679 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10680 }
10681 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
10682
10683 free (buf);
10684 return NULL;
10685 }
10686
10687 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10688 char *
10689 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
10690 char *buf,
10691 int *bufsiz,
10692 long pid,
10693 int cursig,
10694 const void *gregs)
10695 {
10696 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
10697 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10698
10699 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
10700 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
10701 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10702 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
10703 memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
10704 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10705 #if !defined(gregs)
10706 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
10707 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
10708 #else
10709 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
10710 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
10711 #endif
10712 #endif
10713 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10714 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
10715 }
10716 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
10717
10718 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10719 char *
10720 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
10721 char *buf,
10722 int *bufsiz,
10723 long pid,
10724 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10725 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10726 {
10727 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10728 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
10729 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10730
10731 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10732 {
10733 pstatus32_t pstat;
10734
10735 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10736 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10737 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10738 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10739 return buf;
10740 }
10741 else
10742 #endif
10743 {
10744 pstatus_t pstat;
10745
10746 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10747 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10748 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10749 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10750 return buf;
10751 }
10752 }
10753 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
10754
10755 char *
10756 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10757 char *buf,
10758 int *bufsiz,
10759 const void *fpregs,
10760 int size)
10761 {
10762 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10763 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10764 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
10765 }
10766
10767 char *
10768 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10769 char *buf,
10770 int *bufsiz,
10771 const void *xfpregs,
10772 int size)
10773 {
10774 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10775 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10776 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
10777 }
10778
10779 char *
10780 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10781 const void *xfpregs, int size)
10782 {
10783 char *note_name;
10784 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
10785 note_name = "FreeBSD";
10786 else
10787 note_name = "LINUX";
10788 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10789 note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
10790 }
10791
10792 char *
10793 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
10794 char *buf,
10795 int *bufsiz,
10796 const void *ppc_vmx,
10797 int size)
10798 {
10799 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10800 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10801 note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
10802 }
10803
10804 char *
10805 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
10806 char *buf,
10807 int *bufsiz,
10808 const void *ppc_vsx,
10809 int size)
10810 {
10811 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10812 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10813 note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
10814 }
10815
10816 static char *
10817 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
10818 char *buf,
10819 int *bufsiz,
10820 const void *s390_high_gprs,
10821 int size)
10822 {
10823 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10824 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10825 note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
10826 s390_high_gprs, size);
10827 }
10828
10829 char *
10830 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
10831 char *buf,
10832 int *bufsiz,
10833 const void *s390_timer,
10834 int size)
10835 {
10836 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10837 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10838 note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
10839 }
10840
10841 char *
10842 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
10843 char *buf,
10844 int *bufsiz,
10845 const void *s390_todcmp,
10846 int size)
10847 {
10848 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10849 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10850 note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
10851 }
10852
10853 char *
10854 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
10855 char *buf,
10856 int *bufsiz,
10857 const void *s390_todpreg,
10858 int size)
10859 {
10860 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10861 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10862 note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
10863 }
10864
10865 char *
10866 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
10867 char *buf,
10868 int *bufsiz,
10869 const void *s390_ctrs,
10870 int size)
10871 {
10872 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10873 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10874 note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
10875 }
10876
10877 char *
10878 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
10879 char *buf,
10880 int *bufsiz,
10881 const void *s390_prefix,
10882 int size)
10883 {
10884 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10885 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10886 note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
10887 }
10888
10889 char *
10890 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
10891 char *buf,
10892 int *bufsiz,
10893 const void *s390_last_break,
10894 int size)
10895 {
10896 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10897 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10898 note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
10899 s390_last_break, size);
10900 }
10901
10902 char *
10903 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
10904 char *buf,
10905 int *bufsiz,
10906 const void *s390_system_call,
10907 int size)
10908 {
10909 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10910 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10911 note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
10912 s390_system_call, size);
10913 }
10914
10915 char *
10916 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
10917 char *buf,
10918 int *bufsiz,
10919 const void *s390_tdb,
10920 int size)
10921 {
10922 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10923 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10924 note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
10925 }
10926
10927 char *
10928 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
10929 char *buf,
10930 int *bufsiz,
10931 const void *s390_vxrs_low,
10932 int size)
10933 {
10934 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10935 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10936 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
10937 }
10938
10939 char *
10940 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
10941 char *buf,
10942 int *bufsiz,
10943 const void *s390_vxrs_high,
10944 int size)
10945 {
10946 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10947 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10948 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
10949 s390_vxrs_high, size);
10950 }
10951
10952 char *
10953 elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd,
10954 char *buf,
10955 int *bufsiz,
10956 const void *s390_gs_cb,
10957 int size)
10958 {
10959 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10960 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10961 note_name, NT_S390_GS_CB,
10962 s390_gs_cb, size);
10963 }
10964
10965 char *
10966 elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd,
10967 char *buf,
10968 int *bufsiz,
10969 const void *s390_gs_bc,
10970 int size)
10971 {
10972 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10973 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10974 note_name, NT_S390_GS_BC,
10975 s390_gs_bc, size);
10976 }
10977
10978 char *
10979 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
10980 char *buf,
10981 int *bufsiz,
10982 const void *arm_vfp,
10983 int size)
10984 {
10985 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10986 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10987 note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
10988 }
10989
10990 char *
10991 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
10992 char *buf,
10993 int *bufsiz,
10994 const void *aarch_tls,
10995 int size)
10996 {
10997 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10998 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10999 note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
11000 }
11001
11002 char *
11003 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
11004 char *buf,
11005 int *bufsiz,
11006 const void *aarch_hw_break,
11007 int size)
11008 {
11009 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11010 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11011 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
11012 }
11013
11014 char *
11015 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
11016 char *buf,
11017 int *bufsiz,
11018 const void *aarch_hw_watch,
11019 int size)
11020 {
11021 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11022 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11023 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
11024 }
11025
11026 char *
11027 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
11028 char *buf,
11029 int *bufsiz,
11030 const char *section,
11031 const void *data,
11032 int size)
11033 {
11034 if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
11035 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11036 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
11037 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11038 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
11039 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11040 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
11041 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11042 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
11043 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11044 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
11045 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11046 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
11047 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11048 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
11049 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11050 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
11051 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11052 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
11053 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11054 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
11055 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11056 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
11057 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11058 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
11059 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11060 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
11061 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11062 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
11063 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11064 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
11065 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11066 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
11067 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11068 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
11069 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11070 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
11071 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11072 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
11073 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11074 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
11075 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11076 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
11077 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11078 return NULL;
11079 }
11080
11081 static bfd_boolean
11082 elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset,
11083 size_t align)
11084 {
11085 char *p;
11086
11087 /* NB: CORE PT_NOTE segments may have p_align values of 0 or 1.
11088 gABI specifies that PT_NOTE alignment should be aligned to 4
11089 bytes for 32-bit objects and to 8 bytes for 64-bit objects. If
11090 align is less than 4, we use 4 byte alignment. */
11091 if (align < 4)
11092 align = 4;
11093 if (align != 4 && align != 8)
11094 return FALSE;
11095
11096 p = buf;
11097 while (p < buf + size)
11098 {
11099 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
11100 Elf_Internal_Note in;
11101
11102 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
11103 return FALSE;
11104
11105 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
11106
11107 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
11108 in.namedata = xnp->name;
11109 if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
11110 return FALSE;
11111
11112 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
11113 in.descdata = p + ELF_NOTE_DESC_OFFSET (in.namesz, align);
11114 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
11115 if (in.descsz != 0
11116 && (in.descdata >= buf + size
11117 || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
11118 return FALSE;
11119
11120 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
11121 {
11122 default:
11123 return TRUE;
11124
11125 case bfd_core:
11126 {
11127 #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
11128 struct
11129 {
11130 const char * string;
11131 size_t len;
11132 bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
11133 }
11134 grokers[] =
11135 {
11136 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
11137 GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note),
11138 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
11139 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
11140 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
11141 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note)
11142 };
11143 #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
11144 int i;
11145
11146 for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
11147 {
11148 if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
11149 && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
11150 grokers[i].len) == 0)
11151 {
11152 if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
11153 return FALSE;
11154 break;
11155 }
11156 }
11157 break;
11158 }
11159
11160 case bfd_object:
11161 if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
11162 {
11163 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
11164 return FALSE;
11165 }
11166 else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
11167 && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
11168 {
11169 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
11170 return FALSE;
11171 }
11172 break;
11173 }
11174
11175 p += ELF_NOTE_NEXT_OFFSET (in.namesz, in.descsz, align);
11176 }
11177
11178 return TRUE;
11179 }
11180
11181 static bfd_boolean
11182 elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size,
11183 size_t align)
11184 {
11185 char *buf;
11186
11187 if (size == 0 || (size + 1) == 0)
11188 return TRUE;
11189
11190 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
11191 return FALSE;
11192
11193 buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size + 1);
11194 if (buf == NULL)
11195 return FALSE;
11196
11197 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
11198 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
11199 buf[size] = 0;
11200
11201 if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
11202 || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset, align))
11203 {
11204 free (buf);
11205 return FALSE;
11206 }
11207
11208 free (buf);
11209 return TRUE;
11210 }
11211 \f
11212 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
11213
11214 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
11215 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
11216 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11217
11218 long
11219 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
11220 {
11221 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11222 {
11223 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11224 return -1;
11225 }
11226
11227 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
11228 }
11229
11230 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
11231 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
11232 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
11233 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
11234
11235 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
11236 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11237
11238 int
11239 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
11240 {
11241 int num_phdrs;
11242
11243 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11244 {
11245 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11246 return -1;
11247 }
11248
11249 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
11250 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
11251 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
11252
11253 return num_phdrs;
11254 }
11255
11256 enum elf_reloc_type_class
11257 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11258 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11259 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11260 {
11261 return reloc_class_normal;
11262 }
11263
11264 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
11265 relocation against a local symbol. */
11266
11267 bfd_vma
11268 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11269 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11270 asection **psec,
11271 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
11272 {
11273 asection *sec = *psec;
11274 bfd_vma relocation;
11275
11276 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
11277 + sec->output_offset
11278 + sym->st_value);
11279 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
11280 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
11281 && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11282 {
11283 rel->r_addend =
11284 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11285 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11286 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
11287 if (sec != *psec)
11288 {
11289 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
11290 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
11291 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
11292 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
11293 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
11294 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
11295 sec->kept_section = *psec;
11296 sec = *psec;
11297 }
11298 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
11299 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
11300 }
11301 return relocation;
11302 }
11303
11304 bfd_vma
11305 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11306 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11307 asection **psec,
11308 bfd_vma addend)
11309 {
11310 asection *sec = *psec;
11311
11312 if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11313 return sym->st_value + addend;
11314
11315 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11316 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11317 sym->st_value + addend);
11318 }
11319
11320 /* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
11321 the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
11322 section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
11323 The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
11324 byte may be. */
11325
11326 bfd_vma
11327 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
11328 struct bfd_link_info *info,
11329 asection *sec,
11330 bfd_vma offset)
11331 {
11332 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
11333 {
11334 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
11335 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11336 offset);
11337 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
11338 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
11339
11340 default:
11341 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
11342 {
11343 /* Reverse the offset. */
11344 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11345 bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
11346
11347 /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
11348 to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
11349 offset = (sec->size - address_size) / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd) - offset;
11350 }
11351 return offset;
11352 }
11353 }
11354 \f
11355 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
11356 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
11357 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
11358 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
11359 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
11360 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
11361
11362 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
11363 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
11364 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
11365 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
11366 the remote memory. */
11367
11368 bfd *
11369 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
11370 (bfd *templ,
11371 bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
11372 bfd_size_type size,
11373 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
11374 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
11375 {
11376 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
11377 (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
11378 }
11379 \f
11380 long
11381 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
11382 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11383 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11384 long dynsymcount,
11385 asymbol **dynsyms,
11386 asymbol **ret)
11387 {
11388 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11389 asection *relplt;
11390 asymbol *s;
11391 const char *relplt_name;
11392 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
11393 arelent *p;
11394 long count, i, n;
11395 size_t size;
11396 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
11397 char *names;
11398 asection *plt;
11399
11400 *ret = NULL;
11401
11402 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
11403 return 0;
11404
11405 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
11406 return 0;
11407
11408 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
11409 return 0;
11410
11411 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
11412 if (relplt_name == NULL)
11413 relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
11414 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
11415 if (relplt == NULL)
11416 return 0;
11417
11418 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
11419 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
11420 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
11421 return 0;
11422
11423 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
11424 if (plt == NULL)
11425 return 0;
11426
11427 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
11428 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
11429 return -1;
11430
11431 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
11432 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
11433 p = relplt->relocation;
11434 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11435 {
11436 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
11437 if (p->addend != 0)
11438 {
11439 #ifdef BFD64
11440 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
11441 #else
11442 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
11443 #endif
11444 }
11445 }
11446
11447 s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
11448 if (s == NULL)
11449 return -1;
11450
11451 names = (char *) (s + count);
11452 p = relplt->relocation;
11453 n = 0;
11454 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11455 {
11456 size_t len;
11457 bfd_vma addr;
11458
11459 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
11460 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
11461 continue;
11462
11463 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
11464 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
11465 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
11466 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
11467 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
11468 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
11469 s->section = plt;
11470 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
11471 s->name = names;
11472 s->udata.p = NULL;
11473 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
11474 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
11475 names += len;
11476 if (p->addend != 0)
11477 {
11478 char buf[30], *a;
11479
11480 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
11481 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
11482 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
11483 for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
11484 ;
11485 len = strlen (a);
11486 memcpy (names, a, len);
11487 names += len;
11488 }
11489 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
11490 names += sizeof ("@plt");
11491 ++s, ++n;
11492 }
11493
11494 return n;
11495 }
11496
11497 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
11498 ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
11499 but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. */
11500 static const asymbol lcomm_sym
11501 = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section);
11502 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
11503 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section, &lcomm_sym,
11504 "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON);
11505
11506 void
11507 _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (bfd * abfd,
11508 struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11509 {
11510 Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
11511
11512 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
11513
11514 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
11515
11516 /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
11517 osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
11518 the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
11519 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
11520 && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
11521 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
11522 }
11523
11524
11525 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
11526 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
11527 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
11528
11529 bfd_boolean
11530 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
11531 {
11532 return (type == STT_FUNC
11533 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
11534 }
11535
11536 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
11537 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
11538 otherwise return zero. */
11539
11540 bfd_size_type
11541 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
11542 bfd_vma *code_off)
11543 {
11544 bfd_size_type size;
11545
11546 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
11547 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
11548 || sym->section != sec)
11549 return 0;
11550
11551 *code_off = sym->value;
11552 size = 0;
11553 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
11554 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
11555 if (size == 0)
11556 size = 1;
11557 return size;
11558 }
This page took 0.462727 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.